LCOV - code coverage report
Current view: top level - src/backend/access/transam - xlog.c (source / functions) Hit Total Coverage
Test: PostgreSQL 17devel Lines: 2143 2438 87.9 %
Date: 2024-04-20 06:11:45 Functions: 118 120 98.3 %
Legend: Lines: hit not hit

          Line data    Source code
       1             : /*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
       2             :  *
       3             :  * xlog.c
       4             :  *      PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
       5             :  *
       6             :  * The Write-Ahead Log (WAL) functionality is split into several source
       7             :  * files, in addition to this one:
       8             :  *
       9             :  * xloginsert.c - Functions for constructing WAL records
      10             :  * xlogrecovery.c - WAL recovery and standby code
      11             :  * xlogreader.c - Facility for reading WAL files and parsing WAL records
      12             :  * xlogutils.c - Helper functions for WAL redo routines
      13             :  *
      14             :  * This file contains functions for coordinating database startup and
      15             :  * checkpointing, and managing the write-ahead log buffers when the
      16             :  * system is running.
      17             :  *
      18             :  * StartupXLOG() is the main entry point of the startup process.  It
      19             :  * coordinates database startup, performing WAL recovery, and the
      20             :  * transition from WAL recovery into normal operations.
      21             :  *
      22             :  * XLogInsertRecord() inserts a WAL record into the WAL buffers.  Most
      23             :  * callers should not call this directly, but use the functions in
      24             :  * xloginsert.c to construct the WAL record.  XLogFlush() can be used
      25             :  * to force the WAL to disk.
      26             :  *
      27             :  * In addition to those, there are many other functions for interrogating
      28             :  * the current system state, and for starting/stopping backups.
      29             :  *
      30             :  *
      31             :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2024, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
      32             :  * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
      33             :  *
      34             :  * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
      35             :  *
      36             :  *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
      37             :  */
      38             : 
      39             : #include "postgres.h"
      40             : 
      41             : #include <ctype.h>
      42             : #include <math.h>
      43             : #include <time.h>
      44             : #include <fcntl.h>
      45             : #include <sys/stat.h>
      46             : #include <sys/time.h>
      47             : #include <unistd.h>
      48             : 
      49             : #include "access/clog.h"
      50             : #include "access/commit_ts.h"
      51             : #include "access/heaptoast.h"
      52             : #include "access/multixact.h"
      53             : #include "access/rewriteheap.h"
      54             : #include "access/subtrans.h"
      55             : #include "access/timeline.h"
      56             : #include "access/transam.h"
      57             : #include "access/twophase.h"
      58             : #include "access/xact.h"
      59             : #include "access/xlog_internal.h"
      60             : #include "access/xlogarchive.h"
      61             : #include "access/xloginsert.h"
      62             : #include "access/xlogreader.h"
      63             : #include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
      64             : #include "access/xlogutils.h"
      65             : #include "backup/basebackup.h"
      66             : #include "catalog/catversion.h"
      67             : #include "catalog/pg_control.h"
      68             : #include "catalog/pg_database.h"
      69             : #include "common/controldata_utils.h"
      70             : #include "common/file_utils.h"
      71             : #include "executor/instrument.h"
      72             : #include "miscadmin.h"
      73             : #include "pg_trace.h"
      74             : #include "pgstat.h"
      75             : #include "port/atomics.h"
      76             : #include "port/pg_iovec.h"
      77             : #include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
      78             : #include "postmaster/startup.h"
      79             : #include "postmaster/walsummarizer.h"
      80             : #include "postmaster/walwriter.h"
      81             : #include "replication/origin.h"
      82             : #include "replication/slot.h"
      83             : #include "replication/snapbuild.h"
      84             : #include "replication/walreceiver.h"
      85             : #include "replication/walsender.h"
      86             : #include "storage/bufmgr.h"
      87             : #include "storage/fd.h"
      88             : #include "storage/ipc.h"
      89             : #include "storage/large_object.h"
      90             : #include "storage/latch.h"
      91             : #include "storage/predicate.h"
      92             : #include "storage/proc.h"
      93             : #include "storage/procarray.h"
      94             : #include "storage/reinit.h"
      95             : #include "storage/spin.h"
      96             : #include "storage/sync.h"
      97             : #include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
      98             : #include "utils/guc_tables.h"
      99             : #include "utils/injection_point.h"
     100             : #include "utils/memutils.h"
     101             : #include "utils/ps_status.h"
     102             : #include "utils/relmapper.h"
     103             : #include "utils/snapmgr.h"
     104             : #include "utils/timeout.h"
     105             : #include "utils/timestamp.h"
     106             : #include "utils/varlena.h"
     107             : 
     108             : extern uint32 bootstrap_data_checksum_version;
     109             : 
     110             : /* timeline ID to be used when bootstrapping */
     111             : #define BootstrapTimeLineID     1
     112             : 
     113             : /* User-settable parameters */
     114             : int         max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
     115             : int         min_wal_size_mb = 80;   /* 80 MB */
     116             : int         wal_keep_size_mb = 0;
     117             : int         XLOGbuffers = -1;
     118             : int         XLogArchiveTimeout = 0;
     119             : int         XLogArchiveMode = ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF;
     120             : char       *XLogArchiveCommand = NULL;
     121             : bool        EnableHotStandby = false;
     122             : bool        fullPageWrites = true;
     123             : bool        wal_log_hints = false;
     124             : int         wal_compression = WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE;
     125             : char       *wal_consistency_checking_string = NULL;
     126             : bool       *wal_consistency_checking = NULL;
     127             : bool        wal_init_zero = true;
     128             : bool        wal_recycle = true;
     129             : bool        log_checkpoints = true;
     130             : int         wal_sync_method = DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD;
     131             : int         wal_level = WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA;
     132             : int         CommitDelay = 0;    /* precommit delay in microseconds */
     133             : int         CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
     134             : int         wal_retrieve_retry_interval = 5000;
     135             : int         max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb = -1;
     136             : int         wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024;
     137             : bool        track_wal_io_timing = false;
     138             : 
     139             : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     140             : bool        XLOG_DEBUG = false;
     141             : #endif
     142             : 
     143             : int         wal_segment_size = DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE;
     144             : 
     145             : /*
     146             :  * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
     147             :  * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
     148             :  * which needs to iterate all the locks.
     149             :  */
     150             : #define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS  8
     151             : 
     152             : /*
     153             :  * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
     154             :  * checkpoint.
     155             :  */
     156             : int         CheckPointSegments;
     157             : 
     158             : /* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
     159             : static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate = 0;
     160             : static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
     161             : 
     162             : /*
     163             :  * Track whether there were any deferred checks for custom resource managers
     164             :  * specified in wal_consistency_checking.
     165             :  */
     166             : static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false;
     167             : 
     168             : /*
     169             :  * GUC support
     170             :  */
     171             : const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[] = {
     172             :     {"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
     173             : #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
     174             :     {"fsync_writethrough", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
     175             : #endif
     176             :     {"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
     177             : #ifdef O_SYNC
     178             :     {"open_sync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
     179             : #endif
     180             : #ifdef O_DSYNC
     181             :     {"open_datasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
     182             : #endif
     183             :     {NULL, 0, false}
     184             : };
     185             : 
     186             : 
     187             : /*
     188             :  * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
     189             :  * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
     190             :  */
     191             : const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[] = {
     192             :     {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
     193             :     {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
     194             :     {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
     195             :     {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     196             :     {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     197             :     {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     198             :     {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     199             :     {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
     200             :     {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
     201             :     {NULL, 0, false}
     202             : };
     203             : 
     204             : /*
     205             :  * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
     206             :  * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
     207             :  * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
     208             :  */
     209             : CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats;
     210             : 
     211             : /*
     212             :  * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
     213             :  * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
     214             :  * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
     215             :  * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
     216             :  */
     217             : static bool lastFullPageWrites;
     218             : 
     219             : /*
     220             :  * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
     221             :  * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.  True actually
     222             :  * means "not known, need to check the shared state".
     223             :  */
     224             : static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
     225             : 
     226             : /*
     227             :  * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
     228             :  *      1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
     229             :  *      0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
     230             :  *      -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
     231             :  * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
     232             :  * is not in progress.  But we can also force the value for special cases.
     233             :  * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
     234             :  * being numerically the same as bool true and false.
     235             :  */
     236             : static int  LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1;
     237             : 
     238             : /*
     239             :  * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
     240             :  * current backend.  It is updated for all inserts.  XactLastRecEnd points to
     241             :  * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
     242             :  * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
     243             :  * created any XLOG records.
     244             :  *
     245             :  * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date.  When committing,
     246             :  * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
     247             :  * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
     248             :  * the transaction.  But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
     249             :  * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
     250             :  * stored here.  The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
     251             :  * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
     252             :  */
     253             : XLogRecPtr  ProcLastRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     254             : XLogRecPtr  XactLastRecEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     255             : XLogRecPtr  XactLastCommitEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     256             : 
     257             : /*
     258             :  * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
     259             :  * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
     260             :  * CHECKPOINT record).  We update this from the shared-memory copy,
     261             :  * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
     262             :  * hold an insertion lock).  See XLogInsertRecord for details.  We are also
     263             :  * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
     264             :  * see GetRedoRecPtr.
     265             :  *
     266             :  * NB: Code that uses this variable must be prepared not only for the
     267             :  * possibility that it may be arbitrarily out of date, but also for the
     268             :  * possibility that it might be set to InvalidXLogRecPtr. We used to
     269             :  * initialize it as a side effect of the first call to RecoveryInProgress(),
     270             :  * which meant that most code that might use it could assume that it had a
     271             :  * real if perhaps stale value. That's no longer the case.
     272             :  */
     273             : static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr;
     274             : 
     275             : /*
     276             :  * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (fullPageWrites ||
     277             :  * runningBackups > 0).  It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
     278             :  * a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
     279             :  *
     280             :  * NB: Initially this is false, and there's no guarantee that it will be
     281             :  * initialized to any other value before it is first used. Any code that
     282             :  * makes use of it must recheck the value after obtaining a WALInsertLock,
     283             :  * and respond appropriately if it turns out that the previous value wasn't
     284             :  * accurate.
     285             :  */
     286             : static bool doPageWrites;
     287             : 
     288             : /*----------
     289             :  * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
     290             :  *
     291             :  * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
     292             :  * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
     293             :  * The positions already written/fsynced are maintained in logWriteResult
     294             :  * and logFlushResult using atomic access.
     295             :  * In addition to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of
     296             :  * both in LogwrtResult, which is updated when convenient.
     297             :  *
     298             :  * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
     299             :  * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
     300             :  *
     301             :  * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
     302             :  * so it's a plain spinlock.  The other locks are held longer (potentially
     303             :  * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them.  These locks are:
     304             :  *
     305             :  * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
     306             :  * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping.  If the
     307             :  * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
     308             :  * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
     309             :  *
     310             :  * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
     311             :  * XLogFlush).
     312             :  *
     313             :  * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
     314             :  * new log file.
     315             :  *
     316             :  *----------
     317             :  */
     318             : 
     319             : typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
     320             : {
     321             :     XLogRecPtr  Write;          /* last byte + 1 to write out */
     322             :     XLogRecPtr  Flush;          /* last byte + 1 to flush */
     323             : } XLogwrtRqst;
     324             : 
     325             : typedef struct XLogwrtResult
     326             : {
     327             :     XLogRecPtr  Write;          /* last byte + 1 written out */
     328             :     XLogRecPtr  Flush;          /* last byte + 1 flushed */
     329             : } XLogwrtResult;
     330             : 
     331             : /*
     332             :  * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
     333             :  * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
     334             :  * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
     335             :  * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
     336             :  * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
     337             :  *
     338             :  * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
     339             :  * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
     340             :  * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
     341             :  * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
     342             :  * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
     343             :  * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
     344             :  * you're about to write out.
     345             :  *
     346             :  * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
     347             :  * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
     348             :  * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
     349             :  * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
     350             :  * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
     351             :  * insertion.
     352             :  *
     353             :  * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
     354             :  * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
     355             :  * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
     356             :  * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
     357             :  *
     358             :  * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
     359             :  * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
     360             :  * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
     361             :  * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
     362             :  * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
     363             :  * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
     364             :  * records.  Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
     365             :  * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
     366             :  */
     367             : typedef struct
     368             : {
     369             :     LWLock      lock;
     370             :     pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt;
     371             :     XLogRecPtr  lastImportantAt;
     372             : } WALInsertLock;
     373             : 
     374             : /*
     375             :  * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
     376             :  * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
     377             :  * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
     378             :  * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
     379             :  * array start address is suitably aligned.)
     380             :  */
     381             : typedef union WALInsertLockPadded
     382             : {
     383             :     WALInsertLock l;
     384             :     char        pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
     385             : } WALInsertLockPadded;
     386             : 
     387             : /*
     388             :  * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
     389             :  * functions to start and stop backups.
     390             :  */
     391             : static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
     392             : 
     393             : /*
     394             :  * Shared state data for WAL insertion.
     395             :  */
     396             : typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
     397             : {
     398             :     slock_t     insertpos_lck;  /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
     399             : 
     400             :     /*
     401             :      * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
     402             :      * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
     403             :      * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
     404             :      * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
     405             :      * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
     406             :      */
     407             :     uint64      CurrBytePos;
     408             :     uint64      PrevBytePos;
     409             : 
     410             :     /*
     411             :      * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
     412             :      * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
     413             :      * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
     414             :      * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
     415             :      * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
     416             :      */
     417             :     char        pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE];
     418             : 
     419             :     /*
     420             :      * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
     421             :      * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
     422             :      * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
     423             :      * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
     424             :      * actually affects WAL-logging by backends.  Checkpointer sets at startup
     425             :      * or after SIGHUP.
     426             :      *
     427             :      * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
     428             :      * you must hold ALL the locks.
     429             :      */
     430             :     XLogRecPtr  RedoRecPtr;     /* current redo point for insertions */
     431             :     bool        fullPageWrites;
     432             : 
     433             :     /*
     434             :      * runningBackups is a counter indicating the number of backups currently
     435             :      * in progress. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location
     436             :      * used as a starting point for an online backup.
     437             :      */
     438             :     int         runningBackups;
     439             :     XLogRecPtr  lastBackupStart;
     440             : 
     441             :     /*
     442             :      * WAL insertion locks.
     443             :      */
     444             :     WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks;
     445             : } XLogCtlInsert;
     446             : 
     447             : /*
     448             :  * Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
     449             :  */
     450             : typedef struct XLogCtlData
     451             : {
     452             :     XLogCtlInsert Insert;
     453             : 
     454             :     /* Protected by info_lck: */
     455             :     XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst;
     456             :     XLogRecPtr  RedoRecPtr;     /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
     457             :     FullTransactionId ckptFullXid;  /* nextXid of latest checkpoint */
     458             :     XLogRecPtr  asyncXactLSN;   /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
     459             :     XLogRecPtr  replicationSlotMinLSN;  /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
     460             : 
     461             :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;   /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
     462             : 
     463             :     /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. */
     464             :     pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN;
     465             : 
     466             :     /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
     467             :     pg_time_t   lastSegSwitchTime;
     468             :     XLogRecPtr  lastSegSwitchLSN;
     469             : 
     470             :     /* These are accessed using atomics -- info_lck not needed */
     471             :     pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult;   /* last byte + 1 inserted to buffers */
     472             :     pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult;    /* last byte + 1 written out */
     473             :     pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult;    /* last byte + 1 flushed */
     474             : 
     475             :     /*
     476             :      * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
     477             :      *
     478             :      * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
     479             :      * hold WALBufMappingLock.  To change the identity of a buffer that's
     480             :      * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
     481             :      * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
     482             :      * in-progress insertions to the page by calling
     483             :      * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
     484             :      */
     485             :     XLogRecPtr  InitializedUpTo;
     486             : 
     487             :     /*
     488             :      * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
     489             :      * and xlblocks values certainly do.  xlblocks values are protected by
     490             :      * WALBufMappingLock.
     491             :      */
     492             :     char       *pages;          /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
     493             :     pg_atomic_uint64 *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
     494             :     int         XLogCacheBlck;  /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
     495             : 
     496             :     /*
     497             :      * InsertTimeLineID is the timeline into which new WAL is being inserted
     498             :      * and flushed. It is zero during recovery, and does not change once set.
     499             :      *
     500             :      * If we create a new timeline when the system was started up,
     501             :      * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
     502             :      * Otherwise it's equal to InsertTimeLineID.
     503             :      */
     504             :     TimeLineID  InsertTimeLineID;
     505             :     TimeLineID  PrevTimeLineID;
     506             : 
     507             :     /*
     508             :      * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
     509             :      * recovery.  Protected by info_lck.
     510             :      */
     511             :     RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState;
     512             : 
     513             :     /*
     514             :      * InstallXLogFileSegmentActive indicates whether the checkpointer should
     515             :      * arrange for future segments by recycling and/or PreallocXlogFiles().
     516             :      * Protected by ControlFileLock.  Only the startup process changes it.  If
     517             :      * true, anyone can use InstallXLogFileSegment().  If false, the startup
     518             :      * process owns the exclusive right to install segments, by reading from
     519             :      * the archive and possibly replacing existing files.
     520             :      */
     521             :     bool        InstallXLogFileSegmentActive;
     522             : 
     523             :     /*
     524             :      * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
     525             :      * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
     526             :      * Protected by info_lck.
     527             :      */
     528             :     bool        WalWriterSleeping;
     529             : 
     530             :     /*
     531             :      * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
     532             :      * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
     533             :      * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record.  Used by the
     534             :      * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
     535             :      *
     536             :      * Protected by info_lck.
     537             :      */
     538             :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointRecPtr;
     539             :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointEndPtr;
     540             :     CheckPoint  lastCheckPoint;
     541             : 
     542             :     /*
     543             :      * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
     544             :      * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
     545             :      */
     546             :     XLogRecPtr  lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
     547             : 
     548             :     slock_t     info_lck;       /* locks shared variables shown above */
     549             : } XLogCtlData;
     550             : 
     551             : /*
     552             :  * Classification of XLogRecordInsert operations.
     553             :  */
     554             : typedef enum
     555             : {
     556             :     WALINSERT_NORMAL,
     557             :     WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH,
     558             :     WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
     559             : } WalInsertClass;
     560             : 
     561             : static XLogCtlData *XLogCtl = NULL;
     562             : 
     563             : /* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
     564             : static WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks = NULL;
     565             : 
     566             : /*
     567             :  * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
     568             :  */
     569             : static ControlFileData *ControlFile = NULL;
     570             : 
     571             : /*
     572             :  * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
     573             :  * multiple evaluation!
     574             :  */
     575             : #define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)    \
     576             :     (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
     577             : 
     578             : /* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
     579             : #define NextBufIdx(idx)     \
     580             :         (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
     581             : 
     582             : /*
     583             :  * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
     584             :  * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
     585             :  */
     586             : #define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)  \
     587             :     (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
     588             : 
     589             : /*
     590             :  * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
     591             :  */
     592             : #define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
     593             : 
     594             : /*
     595             :  * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
     596             :  * Rounds down.
     597             :  */
     598             : #define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)  XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
     599             : 
     600             : /* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
     601             : static int  UsableBytesInSegment;
     602             : 
     603             : /*
     604             :  * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
     605             :  * See discussion above.
     606             :  */
     607             : static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult = {0, 0};
     608             : 
     609             : /*
     610             :  * Update local copy of shared XLogCtl->log{Write,Flush}Result
     611             :  *
     612             :  * It's critical that Flush always trails Write, so the order of the reads is
     613             :  * important, as is the barrier.  See also XLogWrite.
     614             :  */
     615             : #define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target) \
     616             :     do { \
     617             :         _target.Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult); \
     618             :         pg_read_barrier(); \
     619             :         _target.Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult); \
     620             :     } while (0)
     621             : 
     622             : /*
     623             :  * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
     624             :  * openLogSegNo identifies the segment, and openLogTLI the corresponding TLI.
     625             :  * These variables are only used to write the XLOG, and so will normally refer
     626             :  * to the active segment.
     627             :  *
     628             :  * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
     629             :  */
     630             : static int  openLogFile = -1;
     631             : static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo = 0;
     632             : static TimeLineID openLogTLI = 0;
     633             : 
     634             : /*
     635             :  * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file.  When running
     636             :  * crash recovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
     637             :  * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
     638             :  * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
     639             :  * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
     640             :  */
     641             : static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint;
     642             : static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI;
     643             : static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
     644             : 
     645             : /* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
     646             : static int  MyLockNo = 0;
     647             : static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
     648             : 
     649             : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
     650             : static MemoryContext walDebugCxt = NULL;
     651             : #endif
     652             : 
     653             : static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI,
     654             :                                         XLogRecPtr EndOfLog,
     655             :                                         TimeLineID newTLI);
     656             : static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
     657             : static void XLogReportParameters(void);
     658             : static int  LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
     659             : static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
     660             : static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn,
     661             :                                                   XLogRecPtr pagePtr,
     662             :                                                   TimeLineID newTLI);
     663             : static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
     664             : static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo);
     665             : static XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void);
     666             : 
     667             : static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli,
     668             :                                   bool opportunistic);
     669             : static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible);
     670             : static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
     671             :                                    bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno,
     672             :                                    TimeLineID tli);
     673             : static void XLogFileClose(void);
     674             : static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli);
     675             : static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
     676             : static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr,
     677             :                                XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI);
     678             : static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
     679             :                            XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo,
     680             :                            TimeLineID insertTLI);
     681             : static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
     682             : static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
     683             : static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
     684             : static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
     685             : static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void);
     686             : static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier);
     687             : static void WriteControlFile(void);
     688             : static void ReadControlFile(void);
     689             : static void UpdateControlFile(void);
     690             : static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow);
     691             : 
     692             : static int  get_sync_bit(int method);
     693             : 
     694             : static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
     695             :                                 XLogRecData *rdata,
     696             :                                 XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos,
     697             :                                 TimeLineID tli);
     698             : static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
     699             :                                       XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
     700             : static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
     701             :                               XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr);
     702             : static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto);
     703             : static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli);
     704             : static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
     705             : static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos);
     706             : static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr);
     707             : 
     708             : static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
     709             : static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
     710             : static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
     711             : static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
     712             : 
     713             : /*
     714             :  * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
     715             :  * chunks.  This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
     716             :  * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
     717             :  *
     718             :  * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
     719             :  * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
     720             :  * images.  If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
     721             :  * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr.  The caller can then recalculate
     722             :  * which pages need a full-page image, and retry.  If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
     723             :  * record is always inserted.
     724             :  *
     725             :  * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
     726             :  * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
     727             :  *
     728             :  * 'topxid_included' tells whether the top-transaction id is logged along with
     729             :  * current subtransaction. See XLogRecordAssemble().
     730             :  *
     731             :  * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
     732             :  * data must be MAXALIGNed.  XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
     733             :  * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
     734             :  * by the caller.
     735             :  *
     736             :  * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
     737             :  * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
     738             :  * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
     739             :  * before the data page can be written out.  This implements the basic
     740             :  * WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
     741             :  */
     742             : XLogRecPtr
     743    25544364 : XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata,
     744             :                  XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn,
     745             :                  uint8 flags,
     746             :                  int num_fpi,
     747             :                  bool topxid_included)
     748             : {
     749    25544364 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
     750             :     pg_crc32c   rdata_crc;
     751             :     bool        inserted;
     752    25544364 :     XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
     753    25544364 :     uint8       info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
     754    25544364 :     WalInsertClass class = WALINSERT_NORMAL;
     755             :     XLogRecPtr  StartPos;
     756             :     XLogRecPtr  EndPos;
     757    25544364 :     bool        prevDoPageWrites = doPageWrites;
     758             :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
     759             : 
     760             :     /* Does this record type require special handling? */
     761    25544364 :     if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
     762             :     {
     763      340720 :         if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
     764         666 :             class = WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH;
     765      340054 :         else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
     766         666 :             class = WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT;
     767             :     }
     768             : 
     769             :     /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
     770             :     Assert(rdata->len >= SizeOfXLogRecord);
     771             : 
     772             :     /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
     773    25544364 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
     774           0 :         elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
     775             : 
     776             :     /*
     777             :      * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
     778             :      * change, so we can read it without a lock.
     779             :      */
     780    25544364 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
     781             : 
     782             :     /*----------
     783             :      *
     784             :      * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
     785             :      * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
     786             :      * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
     787             :      *
     788             :      * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
     789             :      *    reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
     790             :      *    insertpos_lck.
     791             :      *
     792             :      * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
     793             :      *    correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
     794             :      *    record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
     795             :      *
     796             :      * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
     797             :      * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
     798             :      * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
     799             :      * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
     800             :      * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
     801             :      * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
     802             :      * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
     803             :      *
     804             :      * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
     805             :      * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
     806             :      *
     807             :      * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
     808             :      * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
     809             :      * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
     810             :      * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
     811             :      *
     812             :      *----------
     813             :      */
     814    25544364 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
     815             : 
     816    25544364 :     if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
     817             :     {
     818    25543032 :         WALInsertLockAcquire();
     819             : 
     820             :         /*
     821             :          * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
     822             :          * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
     823             :          * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
     824             :          * this case and fast otherwise.
     825             :          *
     826             :          * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
     827             :          * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
     828             :          * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
     829             :          *
     830             :          * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
     831             :          * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
     832             :          * our local copy but not force a recomputation.  (If doPageWrites was
     833             :          * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
     834             :          * but we choose not to bother.)
     835             :          */
     836    25543032 :         if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
     837             :         {
     838             :             Assert(RedoRecPtr < Insert->RedoRecPtr);
     839       10050 :             RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
     840             :         }
     841    25543032 :         doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
     842             : 
     843    25543032 :         if (doPageWrites &&
     844    25121604 :             (!prevDoPageWrites ||
     845    23904742 :              (fpw_lsn != InvalidXLogRecPtr && fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr)))
     846             :         {
     847             :             /*
     848             :              * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
     849             :              * didn't back up.  Start over.
     850             :              */
     851       11318 :             WALInsertLockRelease();
     852       11318 :             END_CRIT_SECTION();
     853       11318 :             return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
     854             :         }
     855             : 
     856             :         /*
     857             :          * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
     858             :          * pointer.
     859             :          */
     860    25531714 :         ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
     861             :                                   &rechdr->xl_prev);
     862             : 
     863             :         /* Normal records are always inserted. */
     864    25531714 :         inserted = true;
     865             :     }
     866        1332 :     else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
     867             :     {
     868             :         /*
     869             :          * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
     870             :          * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
     871             :          * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
     872             :          * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
     873             :          *
     874             :          * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
     875             :          * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
     876             :          * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
     877             :          * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
     878             :          */
     879             :         Assert(fpw_lsn == InvalidXLogRecPtr);
     880         666 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
     881         666 :         inserted = ReserveXLogSwitch(&StartPos, &EndPos, &rechdr->xl_prev);
     882             :     }
     883             :     else
     884             :     {
     885             :         Assert(class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT);
     886             : 
     887             :         /*
     888             :          * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
     889             :          * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
     890             :          * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
     891             :          * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
     892             :          * update it afterwards.
     893             :          */
     894             :         Assert(fpw_lsn == InvalidXLogRecPtr);
     895         666 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
     896         666 :         ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
     897             :                                   &rechdr->xl_prev);
     898         666 :         RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
     899         666 :         inserted = true;
     900             :     }
     901             : 
     902    25533046 :     if (inserted)
     903             :     {
     904             :         /*
     905             :          * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
     906             :          * header.
     907             :          */
     908    25532950 :         rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
     909    25532950 :         COMP_CRC32C(rdata_crc, rechdr, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
     910    25532950 :         FIN_CRC32C(rdata_crc);
     911    25532950 :         rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
     912             : 
     913             :         /*
     914             :          * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
     915             :          * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
     916             :          */
     917    25532950 :         CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len,
     918             :                             class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH, rdata,
     919             :                             StartPos, EndPos, insertTLI);
     920             : 
     921             :         /*
     922             :          * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
     923             :          * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
     924             :          * update the first one.
     925             :          */
     926    25532950 :         if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
     927             :         {
     928    25383164 :             int         lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
     929             : 
     930    25383164 :             WALInsertLocks[lockno].l.lastImportantAt = StartPos;
     931             :         }
     932             :     }
     933             :     else
     934             :     {
     935             :         /*
     936             :          * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
     937             :          * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
     938             :          * to do anything.
     939             :          */
     940             :     }
     941             : 
     942             :     /*
     943             :      * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
     944             :      */
     945    25533046 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
     946             : 
     947    25533046 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
     948             : 
     949    25533046 :     MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny();
     950             : 
     951             :     /*
     952             :      * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
     953             :      * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
     954             :      */
     955    25533046 :     if (topxid_included)
     956         434 :         MarkSubxactTopXidLogged();
     957             : 
     958             :     /*
     959             :      * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
     960             :      */
     961    25533046 :     if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
     962             :     {
     963      545620 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
     964             :         /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
     965      545620 :         if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < EndPos)
     966      545244 :             XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndPos;
     967      545620 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
     968      545620 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
     969             :     }
     970             : 
     971             :     /*
     972             :      * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
     973             :      * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
     974             :      * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
     975             :      */
     976    25533046 :     if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
     977             :     {
     978             :         TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_SWITCH();
     979         666 :         XLogFlush(EndPos);
     980             : 
     981             :         /*
     982             :          * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
     983             :          * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
     984             :          * xlog-switch record.
     985             :          */
     986         666 :         if (inserted)
     987             :         {
     988         570 :             EndPos = StartPos + SizeOfXLogRecord;
     989         570 :             if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
     990             :             {
     991           0 :                 uint64      offset = XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size);
     992             : 
     993           0 :                 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
     994           0 :                     EndPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
     995             :                 else
     996           0 :                     EndPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
     997             :             }
     998             :         }
     999             :     }
    1000             : 
    1001             : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    1002             :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    1003             :     {
    1004             :         static XLogReaderState *debug_reader = NULL;
    1005             :         XLogRecord *record;
    1006             :         DecodedXLogRecord *decoded;
    1007             :         StringInfoData buf;
    1008             :         StringInfoData recordBuf;
    1009             :         char       *errormsg = NULL;
    1010             :         MemoryContext oldCxt;
    1011             : 
    1012             :         oldCxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(walDebugCxt);
    1013             : 
    1014             :         initStringInfo(&buf);
    1015             :         appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
    1016             : 
    1017             :         /*
    1018             :          * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
    1019             :          * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
    1020             :          * contiguous chunk.
    1021             :          */
    1022             :         initStringInfo(&recordBuf);
    1023             :         for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
    1024             :             appendBinaryStringInfo(&recordBuf, rdata->data, rdata->len);
    1025             : 
    1026             :         /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
    1027             :         record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
    1028             :         decoded = (DecodedXLogRecord *)
    1029             :             palloc(DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(record->xl_tot_len));
    1030             : 
    1031             :         if (!debug_reader)
    1032             :             debug_reader = XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL,
    1033             :                                               XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
    1034             :                                                          .segment_open = NULL,
    1035             :                                                          .segment_close = NULL),
    1036             :                                               NULL);
    1037             :         if (!debug_reader)
    1038             :         {
    1039             :             appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
    1040             :         }
    1041             :         else if (!DecodeXLogRecord(debug_reader,
    1042             :                                    decoded,
    1043             :                                    record,
    1044             :                                    EndPos,
    1045             :                                    &errormsg))
    1046             :         {
    1047             :             appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
    1048             :                              errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
    1049             :         }
    1050             :         else
    1051             :         {
    1052             :             appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
    1053             : 
    1054             :             debug_reader->record = decoded;
    1055             :             xlog_outdesc(&buf, debug_reader);
    1056             :             debug_reader->record = NULL;
    1057             :         }
    1058             :         elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
    1059             : 
    1060             :         pfree(decoded);
    1061             :         pfree(buf.data);
    1062             :         pfree(recordBuf.data);
    1063             :         MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldCxt);
    1064             :     }
    1065             : #endif
    1066             : 
    1067             :     /*
    1068             :      * Update our global variables
    1069             :      */
    1070    25533046 :     ProcLastRecPtr = StartPos;
    1071    25533046 :     XactLastRecEnd = EndPos;
    1072             : 
    1073             :     /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
    1074    25533046 :     if (inserted)
    1075             :     {
    1076    25532950 :         pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
    1077    25532950 :         pgWalUsage.wal_records++;
    1078    25532950 :         pgWalUsage.wal_fpi += num_fpi;
    1079             :     }
    1080             : 
    1081    25533046 :     return EndPos;
    1082             : }
    1083             : 
    1084             : /*
    1085             :  * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
    1086             :  * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
    1087             :  * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
    1088             :  * used to set the xl_prev of this record.
    1089             :  *
    1090             :  * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
    1091             :  * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
    1092             :  * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
    1093             :  * busy system.
    1094             :  *
    1095             :  * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
    1096             :  * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
    1097             :  *
    1098             :  * NB: Testing shows that XLogInsertRecord runs faster if this code is inlined;
    1099             :  * however, because there are two call sites, the compiler is reluctant to
    1100             :  * inline. We use pg_attribute_always_inline here to try to convince it.
    1101             :  */
    1102             : static pg_attribute_always_inline void
    1103    25532380 : ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos,
    1104             :                           XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
    1105             : {
    1106    25532380 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1107             :     uint64      startbytepos;
    1108             :     uint64      endbytepos;
    1109             :     uint64      prevbytepos;
    1110             : 
    1111    25532380 :     size = MAXALIGN(size);
    1112             : 
    1113             :     /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
    1114             :     Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1115             : 
    1116             :     /*
    1117             :      * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
    1118             :      * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
    1119             :      * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
    1120             :      * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
    1121             :      * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
    1122             :      * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
    1123             :      * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
    1124             :      * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
    1125             :      */
    1126    25532380 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1127             : 
    1128    25532380 :     startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1129    25532380 :     endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
    1130    25532380 :     prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
    1131    25532380 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
    1132    25532380 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
    1133             : 
    1134    25532380 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1135             : 
    1136    25532380 :     *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1137    25532380 :     *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
    1138    25532380 :     *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
    1139             : 
    1140             :     /*
    1141             :      * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
    1142             :      * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
    1143             :      */
    1144             :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
    1145             :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
    1146             :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
    1147    25532380 : }
    1148             : 
    1149             : /*
    1150             :  * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
    1151             :  *
    1152             :  * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
    1153             :  * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
    1154             :  * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
    1155             :  * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
    1156             :  * reserving any space, and the function returns false.
    1157             : */
    1158             : static bool
    1159         666 : ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
    1160             : {
    1161         666 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1162             :     uint64      startbytepos;
    1163             :     uint64      endbytepos;
    1164             :     uint64      prevbytepos;
    1165         666 :     uint32      size = MAXALIGN(SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1166             :     XLogRecPtr  ptr;
    1167             :     uint32      segleft;
    1168             : 
    1169             :     /*
    1170             :      * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
    1171             :      * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
    1172             :      * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
    1173             :      * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
    1174             :      */
    1175         666 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1176             : 
    1177         666 :     startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1178             : 
    1179         666 :     ptr = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1180         666 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    1181             :     {
    1182          96 :         SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1183          96 :         *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
    1184          96 :         return false;
    1185             :     }
    1186             : 
    1187         570 :     endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
    1188         570 :     prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
    1189             : 
    1190         570 :     *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
    1191         570 :     *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
    1192             : 
    1193         570 :     segleft = wal_segment_size - XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size);
    1194         570 :     if (segleft != wal_segment_size)
    1195             :     {
    1196             :         /* consume the rest of the segment */
    1197         570 :         *EndPos += segleft;
    1198         570 :         endbytepos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos);
    1199             :     }
    1200         570 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
    1201         570 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
    1202             : 
    1203         570 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1204             : 
    1205         570 :     *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
    1206             : 
    1207             :     Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
    1208             :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
    1209             :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
    1210             :     Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
    1211             : 
    1212         570 :     return true;
    1213             : }
    1214             : 
    1215             : /*
    1216             :  * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord.  Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
    1217             :  * area in the WAL.
    1218             :  */
    1219             : static void
    1220    25532950 : CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata,
    1221             :                     XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
    1222             : {
    1223             :     char       *currpos;
    1224             :     int         freespace;
    1225             :     int         written;
    1226             :     XLogRecPtr  CurrPos;
    1227             :     XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
    1228             : 
    1229             :     /*
    1230             :      * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
    1231             :      * inserting to.
    1232             :      */
    1233    25532950 :     CurrPos = StartPos;
    1234    25532950 :     currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1235    25532950 :     freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
    1236             : 
    1237             :     /*
    1238             :      * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
    1239             :      * on this page.
    1240             :      */
    1241             :     Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
    1242             : 
    1243             :     /* Copy record data */
    1244    25532950 :     written = 0;
    1245   113600412 :     while (rdata != NULL)
    1246             :     {
    1247    88067462 :         char       *rdata_data = rdata->data;
    1248    88067462 :         int         rdata_len = rdata->len;
    1249             : 
    1250    88768322 :         while (rdata_len > freespace)
    1251             :         {
    1252             :             /*
    1253             :              * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
    1254             :              */
    1255             :             Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
    1256      700860 :             memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
    1257      700860 :             rdata_data += freespace;
    1258      700860 :             rdata_len -= freespace;
    1259      700860 :             written += freespace;
    1260      700860 :             CurrPos += freespace;
    1261             : 
    1262             :             /*
    1263             :              * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
    1264             :              * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
    1265             :              *
    1266             :              * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
    1267             :              * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
    1268             :              * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
    1269             :              * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
    1270             :              */
    1271      700860 :             currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1272      700860 :             pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
    1273      700860 :             pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
    1274      700860 :             pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
    1275             : 
    1276             :             /* skip over the page header */
    1277      700860 :             if (XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    1278             :             {
    1279         916 :                 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1280         916 :                 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1281             :             }
    1282             :             else
    1283             :             {
    1284      699944 :                 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1285      699944 :                 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1286             :             }
    1287      700860 :             freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
    1288             :         }
    1289             : 
    1290             :         Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
    1291    88067462 :         memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
    1292    88067462 :         currpos += rdata_len;
    1293    88067462 :         CurrPos += rdata_len;
    1294    88067462 :         freespace -= rdata_len;
    1295    88067462 :         written += rdata_len;
    1296             : 
    1297    88067462 :         rdata = rdata->next;
    1298             :     }
    1299             :     Assert(written == write_len);
    1300             : 
    1301             :     /*
    1302             :      * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
    1303             :      * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment.  We
    1304             :      * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
    1305             :      */
    1306    25532950 :     if (isLogSwitch && XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) != 0)
    1307             :     {
    1308             :         /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
    1309             :         Assert(write_len == SizeOfXLogRecord);
    1310             : 
    1311             :         /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
    1312             :         Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0);
    1313             : 
    1314             :         /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
    1315         570 :         CurrPos += freespace;
    1316             : 
    1317             :         /*
    1318             :          * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
    1319             :          * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
    1320             :          * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
    1321             :          * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
    1322             :          */
    1323      899808 :         while (CurrPos < EndPos)
    1324             :         {
    1325             :             /*
    1326             :              * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
    1327             :              * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
    1328             :              * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...).  The page would be left initialized
    1329             :              * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
    1330             :              * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
    1331             :              *
    1332             :              * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
    1333             :              * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
    1334             :              * differ from page to page) are not.  The effect varies with
    1335             :              * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
    1336             :              * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
    1337             :              *
    1338             :              * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
    1339             :              * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
    1340             :              * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
    1341             :              * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
    1342             :              * and zero most of the page.  Then we just zero the page header.
    1343             :              */
    1344      899238 :             currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
    1345     3596952 :             MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    1346             : 
    1347      899238 :             CurrPos += XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1348             :         }
    1349             :     }
    1350             :     else
    1351             :     {
    1352             :         /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
    1353    25532380 :         CurrPos = MAXALIGN64(CurrPos);
    1354             :     }
    1355             : 
    1356    25532950 :     if (CurrPos != EndPos)
    1357           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    1358             :                 errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    1359             :                 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
    1360    25532950 : }
    1361             : 
    1362             : /*
    1363             :  * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
    1364             :  */
    1365             : static void
    1366    25543052 : WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
    1367             : {
    1368             :     bool        immed;
    1369             : 
    1370             :     /*
    1371             :      * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
    1372             :      * the one we used last time.  If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
    1373             :      * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
    1374             :      * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
    1375             :      * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
    1376             :      *
    1377             :      * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
    1378             :      * (semi-)randomly.  This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
    1379             :      * lot of very short connections.
    1380             :      */
    1381             :     static int  lockToTry = -1;
    1382             : 
    1383    25543052 :     if (lockToTry == -1)
    1384       12354 :         lockToTry = MyProcNumber % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    1385    25543052 :     MyLockNo = lockToTry;
    1386             : 
    1387             :     /*
    1388             :      * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
    1389             :      * insert location yet.
    1390             :      */
    1391    25543052 :     immed = LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1392    25543052 :     if (!immed)
    1393             :     {
    1394             :         /*
    1395             :          * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
    1396             :          * time.  On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
    1397             :          * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
    1398             :          * lock that no-one else is using.  On a system with more inserters
    1399             :          * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
    1400             :          * across the locks.
    1401             :          */
    1402         874 :         lockToTry = (lockToTry + 1) % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    1403             :     }
    1404    25543052 : }
    1405             : 
    1406             : /*
    1407             :  * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
    1408             :  * to WAL.
    1409             :  */
    1410             : static void
    1411        4784 : WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
    1412             : {
    1413             :     int         i;
    1414             : 
    1415             :     /*
    1416             :      * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
    1417             :      * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
    1418             :      * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
    1419             :      */
    1420       38272 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
    1421             :     {
    1422       33488 :         LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1423       33488 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1424       33488 :                         &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1425             :                         PG_UINT64_MAX);
    1426             :     }
    1427             :     /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
    1428        4784 :     LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1429             : 
    1430        4784 :     holdingAllLocks = true;
    1431        4784 : }
    1432             : 
    1433             : /*
    1434             :  * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
    1435             :  *
    1436             :  * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
    1437             :  * next time the lock is acquired.
    1438             :  */
    1439             : static void
    1440    25547836 : WALInsertLockRelease(void)
    1441             : {
    1442    25547836 :     if (holdingAllLocks)
    1443             :     {
    1444             :         int         i;
    1445             : 
    1446       43056 :         for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    1447       38272 :             LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1448       38272 :                                   &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1449             :                                   0);
    1450             : 
    1451        4784 :         holdingAllLocks = false;
    1452             :     }
    1453             :     else
    1454             :     {
    1455    25543052 :         LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
    1456    25543052 :                               &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
    1457             :                               0);
    1458             :     }
    1459    25547836 : }
    1460             : 
    1461             : /*
    1462             :  * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
    1463             :  * inserting up to that point.
    1464             :  */
    1465             : static void
    1466     1383174 : WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
    1467             : {
    1468     1383174 :     if (holdingAllLocks)
    1469             :     {
    1470             :         /*
    1471             :          * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
    1472             :          * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
    1473             :          */
    1474      891522 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.lock,
    1475      891522 :                         &WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.insertingAt,
    1476             :                         insertingAt);
    1477             :     }
    1478             :     else
    1479      491652 :         LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock,
    1480      491652 :                         &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt,
    1481             :                         insertingAt);
    1482     1383174 : }
    1483             : 
    1484             : /*
    1485             :  * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
    1486             :  *
    1487             :  * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
    1488             :  * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
    1489             :  * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
    1490             :  * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
    1491             :  *
    1492             :  * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
    1493             :  * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
    1494             :  * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
    1495             :  * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
    1496             :  * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
    1497             :  */
    1498             : static XLogRecPtr
    1499     1250108 : WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
    1500             : {
    1501             :     uint64      bytepos;
    1502             :     XLogRecPtr  inserted;
    1503             :     XLogRecPtr  reservedUpto;
    1504             :     XLogRecPtr  finishedUpto;
    1505     1250108 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1506             :     int         i;
    1507             : 
    1508     1250108 :     if (MyProc == NULL)
    1509           0 :         elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
    1510             : 
    1511             :     /*
    1512             :      * Check if there's any work to do.  Use a barrier to ensure we get the
    1513             :      * freshest value.
    1514             :      */
    1515     1250108 :     inserted = pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    1516     1250108 :     if (upto <= inserted)
    1517      922632 :         return inserted;
    1518             : 
    1519             :     /* Read the current insert position */
    1520      327476 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1521      327476 :     bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    1522      327476 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    1523      327476 :     reservedUpto = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(bytepos);
    1524             : 
    1525             :     /*
    1526             :      * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
    1527             :      * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
    1528             :      * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
    1529             :      * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
    1530             :      * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
    1531             :      * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
    1532             :      */
    1533      327476 :     if (upto > reservedUpto)
    1534             :     {
    1535           0 :         ereport(LOG,
    1536             :                 (errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%X, current position %X/%X",
    1537             :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(upto), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(reservedUpto))));
    1538           0 :         upto = reservedUpto;
    1539             :     }
    1540             : 
    1541             :     /*
    1542             :      * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
    1543             :      * than 'upto'.
    1544             :      *
    1545             :      * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
    1546             :      * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
    1547             :      * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
    1548             :      * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
    1549             :      */
    1550      327476 :     finishedUpto = reservedUpto;
    1551     2947284 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    1552             :     {
    1553     2619808 :         XLogRecPtr  insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1554             : 
    1555             :         do
    1556             :         {
    1557             :             /*
    1558             :              * See if this insertion is in progress.  LWLockWaitForVar will
    1559             :              * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
    1560             :              * by a LWLockUpdateVar call.  When a lock is initially acquired,
    1561             :              * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
    1562             :              * know where it's inserting yet.  We will have to wait for it. If
    1563             :              * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
    1564             :              * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
    1565             :              * calling LWLockUpdateVar.  But if it has to sleep, it will
    1566             :              * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
    1567             :              * sleeping.
    1568             :              *
    1569             :              * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
    1570             :              * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called.  The lack of
    1571             :              * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
    1572             :              * "unused" that have since become used.  This is fine because
    1573             :              * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
    1574             :              * want to wait on anyway.  Not taking a lock to acquire the
    1575             :              * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
    1576             :              * insertingAt values.  This is also fine, because if we read a
    1577             :              * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
    1578             :              * contains atomic operations.
    1579             :              */
    1580     2623076 :             if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
    1581     2623076 :                                  &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt,
    1582             :                                  insertingat, &insertingat))
    1583             :             {
    1584             :                 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
    1585     1905138 :                 insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1586     1905138 :                 break;
    1587             :             }
    1588             : 
    1589             :             /*
    1590             :              * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
    1591             :              * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
    1592             :              */
    1593      717938 :         } while (insertingat < upto);
    1594             : 
    1595     2619808 :         if (insertingat != InvalidXLogRecPtr && insertingat < finishedUpto)
    1596      101702 :             finishedUpto = insertingat;
    1597             :     }
    1598             : 
    1599             :     /*
    1600             :      * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
    1601             :      * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
    1602             :      * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
    1603             :      */
    1604      327476 :     finishedUpto = pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult,
    1605             :                                                    finishedUpto);
    1606             : 
    1607      327476 :     return finishedUpto;
    1608             : }
    1609             : 
    1610             : /*
    1611             :  * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
    1612             :  * given XLogRecPtr.
    1613             :  *
    1614             :  * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
    1615             :  * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
    1616             :  *
    1617             :  * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
    1618             :  * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
    1619             :  * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
    1620             :  * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
    1621             :  * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
    1622             :  * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
    1623             :  * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
    1624             :  * later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
    1625             :  */
    1626             : static char *
    1627    27133068 : GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
    1628             : {
    1629             :     int         idx;
    1630             :     XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    1631             :     static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
    1632             :     static char *cachedPos = NULL;
    1633             :     XLogRecPtr  expectedEndPtr;
    1634             : 
    1635             :     /*
    1636             :      * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
    1637             :      * page as last time.
    1638             :      */
    1639    27133068 :     if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
    1640             :     {
    1641             :         Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
    1642             :         Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
    1643    25362100 :         return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1644             :     }
    1645             : 
    1646             :     /*
    1647             :      * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
    1648             :      * particular buffer.  That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
    1649             :      * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
    1650             :      */
    1651     1770968 :     idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
    1652             : 
    1653             :     /*
    1654             :      * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
    1655             :      * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
    1656             :      * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
    1657             :      * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
    1658             :      * that doesn't happen.
    1659             :      *
    1660             :      * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
    1661             :      * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
    1662             :      * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
    1663             :      * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
    1664             :      * we're looking for.
    1665             :      */
    1666     1770968 :     expectedEndPtr = ptr;
    1667     1770968 :     expectedEndPtr += XLOG_BLCKSZ - ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1668             : 
    1669     1770968 :     endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1670     1770968 :     if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1671             :     {
    1672             :         XLogRecPtr  initializedUpto;
    1673             : 
    1674             :         /*
    1675             :          * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
    1676             :          * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
    1677             :          *
    1678             :          * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
    1679             :          * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
    1680             :          * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
    1681             :          * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
    1682             :          * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
    1683             :          * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
    1684             :          * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
    1685             :          * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
    1686             :          * the page header.
    1687             :          */
    1688     1383174 :         if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
    1689       11112 :             XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) > XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1690       11112 :             initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1691     1372062 :         else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
    1692         854 :                  XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) < XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    1693         378 :             initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1694             :         else
    1695     1371684 :             initializedUpto = ptr;
    1696             : 
    1697     1383174 :         WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(initializedUpto);
    1698             : 
    1699     1383174 :         AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
    1700     1383174 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1701             : 
    1702     1383174 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1703           0 :             elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%X",
    1704             :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
    1705             :     }
    1706             :     else
    1707             :     {
    1708             :         /*
    1709             :          * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
    1710             :          * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
    1711             :          */
    1712      387794 :         pg_memory_barrier();
    1713             :     }
    1714             : 
    1715             :     /*
    1716             :      * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
    1717             :      * offset within the page.
    1718             :      */
    1719     1770968 :     cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1720     1770968 :     cachedPos = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1721             : 
    1722             :     Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
    1723             :     Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
    1724             : 
    1725     1770968 :     return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1726             : }
    1727             : 
    1728             : /*
    1729             :  * Read WAL data directly from WAL buffers, if available. Returns the number
    1730             :  * of bytes read successfully.
    1731             :  *
    1732             :  * Fewer than 'count' bytes may be read if some of the requested WAL data has
    1733             :  * already been evicted.
    1734             :  *
    1735             :  * No locks are taken.
    1736             :  *
    1737             :  * Caller should ensure that it reads no further than LogwrtResult.Write
    1738             :  * (which should have been updated by the caller when determining how far to
    1739             :  * read). The 'tli' argument is only used as a convenient safety check so that
    1740             :  * callers do not read from WAL buffers on a historical timeline.
    1741             :  */
    1742             : Size
    1743       52542 : WALReadFromBuffers(char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count,
    1744             :                    TimeLineID tli)
    1745             : {
    1746       52542 :     char       *pdst = dstbuf;
    1747       52542 :     XLogRecPtr  recptr = startptr;
    1748             :     XLogRecPtr  inserted;
    1749       52542 :     Size        nbytes = count;
    1750             : 
    1751       52542 :     if (RecoveryInProgress() || tli != GetWALInsertionTimeLine())
    1752        1774 :         return 0;
    1753             : 
    1754             :     Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(startptr));
    1755             : 
    1756             :     /*
    1757             :      * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
    1758             :      * buffers before we try to read it.
    1759             :      */
    1760       50768 :     inserted = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    1761       50768 :     if (startptr + count > inserted)
    1762           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    1763             :                 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%X, current position %X/%X",
    1764             :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
    1765             :                        LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(inserted)));
    1766             : 
    1767             :     /*
    1768             :      * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
    1769             :      * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
    1770             :      * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
    1771             :      *
    1772             :      * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
    1773             :      * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
    1774             :      * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
    1775             :      * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
    1776             :      * happens between the two verification steps.
    1777             :      *
    1778             :      * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
    1779             :      * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
    1780             :      */
    1781      120830 :     while (nbytes > 0)
    1782             :     {
    1783       84580 :         uint32      offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1784       84580 :         int         idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr);
    1785             :         XLogRecPtr  expectedEndPtr;
    1786             :         XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    1787             :         const char *page;
    1788             :         const char *psrc;
    1789             :         Size        npagebytes;
    1790             : 
    1791             :         /*
    1792             :          * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
    1793             :          * correct page is present.
    1794             :          */
    1795       84580 :         expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
    1796             : 
    1797             :         /*
    1798             :          * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
    1799             :          * the WAL buffers.
    1800             :          */
    1801       84580 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1802       84580 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1803       14510 :             break;
    1804             : 
    1805             :         /*
    1806             :          * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
    1807             :          * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
    1808             :          * determine how much data to read from this page.
    1809             :          */
    1810       70070 :         page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1811       70070 :         psrc = page + offset;
    1812       70070 :         npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
    1813             : 
    1814             :         /*
    1815             :          * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
    1816             :          * reordered.
    1817             :          */
    1818       70070 :         pg_read_barrier();
    1819             : 
    1820             :         /* data copy */
    1821       70070 :         memcpy(pdst, psrc, npagebytes);
    1822             : 
    1823             :         /*
    1824             :          * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
    1825             :          * reordered.
    1826             :          */
    1827       70070 :         pg_read_barrier();
    1828             : 
    1829             :         /*
    1830             :          * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
    1831             :          * evicted while we were copying the data.
    1832             :          */
    1833       70070 :         endptr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]);
    1834       70070 :         if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
    1835           8 :             break;
    1836             : 
    1837       70062 :         pdst += npagebytes;
    1838       70062 :         recptr += npagebytes;
    1839       70062 :         nbytes -= npagebytes;
    1840             :     }
    1841             : 
    1842             :     Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
    1843             : 
    1844       50768 :     return pdst - dstbuf;
    1845             : }
    1846             : 
    1847             : /*
    1848             :  * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
    1849             :  * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
    1850             :  * page headers.
    1851             :  */
    1852             : static XLogRecPtr
    1853    51071568 : XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
    1854             : {
    1855             :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1856             :     uint64      fullpages;
    1857             :     uint64      bytesleft;
    1858             :     uint32      seg_offset;
    1859             :     XLogRecPtr  result;
    1860             : 
    1861    51071568 :     fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
    1862    51071568 :     bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
    1863             : 
    1864    51071568 :     if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
    1865             :     {
    1866             :         /* fits on first page of segment */
    1867       87866 :         seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1868             :     }
    1869             :     else
    1870             :     {
    1871             :         /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
    1872    50983702 :         seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1873    50983702 :         bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1874             : 
    1875    50983702 :         fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
    1876    50983702 :         bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
    1877             : 
    1878    50983702 :         seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1879             :     }
    1880             : 
    1881    51071568 :     XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
    1882             : 
    1883    51071568 :     return result;
    1884             : }
    1885             : 
    1886             : /*
    1887             :  * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
    1888             :  * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
    1889             :  * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
    1890             :  * when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
    1891             :  */
    1892             : static XLogRecPtr
    1893    25861092 : XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
    1894             : {
    1895             :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1896             :     uint64      fullpages;
    1897             :     uint64      bytesleft;
    1898             :     uint32      seg_offset;
    1899             :     XLogRecPtr  result;
    1900             : 
    1901    25861092 :     fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
    1902    25861092 :     bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
    1903             : 
    1904    25861092 :     if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
    1905             :     {
    1906             :         /* fits on first page of segment */
    1907      132562 :         if (bytesleft == 0)
    1908       87766 :             seg_offset = 0;
    1909             :         else
    1910       44796 :             seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1911             :     }
    1912             :     else
    1913             :     {
    1914             :         /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
    1915    25728530 :         seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1916    25728530 :         bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1917             : 
    1918    25728530 :         fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
    1919    25728530 :         bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
    1920             : 
    1921    25728530 :         if (bytesleft == 0)
    1922       25072 :             seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft;
    1923             :         else
    1924    25703458 :             seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1925             :     }
    1926             : 
    1927    25861092 :     XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
    1928             : 
    1929    25861092 :     return result;
    1930             : }
    1931             : 
    1932             : /*
    1933             :  * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
    1934             :  */
    1935             : static uint64
    1936        3410 : XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
    1937             : {
    1938             :     uint64      fullsegs;
    1939             :     uint32      fullpages;
    1940             :     uint32      offset;
    1941             :     uint64      result;
    1942             : 
    1943        3410 :     XLByteToSeg(ptr, fullsegs, wal_segment_size);
    1944             : 
    1945        3410 :     fullpages = (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size)) / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1946        3410 :     offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    1947             : 
    1948        3410 :     if (fullpages == 0)
    1949             :     {
    1950         966 :         result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
    1951         966 :         if (offset > 0)
    1952             :         {
    1953             :             Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
    1954         366 :             result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    1955             :         }
    1956             :     }
    1957             :     else
    1958             :     {
    1959        2444 :         result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
    1960        2444 :             (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
    1961        2444 :             (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage;    /* full pages */
    1962        2444 :         if (offset > 0)
    1963             :         {
    1964             :             Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    1965        2426 :             result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    1966             :         }
    1967             :     }
    1968             : 
    1969        3410 :     return result;
    1970             : }
    1971             : 
    1972             : /*
    1973             :  * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
    1974             :  * unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
    1975             :  * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
    1976             :  * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
    1977             :  * initialized properly.
    1978             :  */
    1979             : static void
    1980     1385610 : AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
    1981             : {
    1982     1385610 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    1983             :     int         nextidx;
    1984             :     XLogRecPtr  OldPageRqstPtr;
    1985             :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    1986     1385610 :     XLogRecPtr  NewPageEndPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    1987             :     XLogRecPtr  NewPageBeginPtr;
    1988             :     XLogPageHeader NewPage;
    1989     1385610 :     int         npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
    1990             : 
    1991     1385610 :     LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    1992             : 
    1993             :     /*
    1994             :      * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
    1995             :      * already.
    1996             :      */
    1997     4094350 :     while (upto >= XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo || opportunistic)
    1998             :     {
    1999     2711176 :         nextidx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo);
    2000             : 
    2001             :         /*
    2002             :          * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
    2003             :          * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet).  Fall through if it's
    2004             :          * already written out.
    2005             :          */
    2006     2711176 :         OldPageRqstPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx]);
    2007     2711176 :         if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2008             :         {
    2009             :             /*
    2010             :              * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
    2011             :              * as we can without flushing, give up now.
    2012             :              */
    2013     1027314 :             if (opportunistic)
    2014        2436 :                 break;
    2015             : 
    2016             :             /* Advance shared memory write request position */
    2017     1024878 :             SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2018     1024878 :             if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2019      846986 :                 XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
    2020     1024878 :             SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2021             : 
    2022             :             /*
    2023             :              * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
    2024             :              * need to write it or if someone else already did.
    2025             :              */
    2026     1024878 :             RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2027     1024878 :             if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
    2028             :             {
    2029             :                 /*
    2030             :                  * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
    2031             :                  * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
    2032             :                  * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
    2033             :                  * deadlock.
    2034             :                  */
    2035     1020988 :                 LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
    2036             : 
    2037     1020988 :                 WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(OldPageRqstPtr);
    2038             : 
    2039     1020988 :                 LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2040             : 
    2041     1020988 :                 RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2042     1020988 :                 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= OldPageRqstPtr)
    2043             :                 {
    2044             :                     /* OK, someone wrote it already */
    2045        4038 :                     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2046             :                 }
    2047             :                 else
    2048             :                 {
    2049             :                     /* Have to write it ourselves */
    2050             :                     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_START();
    2051     1016950 :                     WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
    2052     1016950 :                     WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
    2053     1016950 :                     XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
    2054     1016950 :                     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2055     1016950 :                     PendingWalStats.wal_buffers_full++;
    2056             :                     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_DONE();
    2057             :                 }
    2058             :                 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
    2059     1020988 :                 LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2060     1020988 :                 continue;
    2061             :             }
    2062             :         }
    2063             : 
    2064             :         /*
    2065             :          * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
    2066             :          * next output page.
    2067             :          */
    2068     1687752 :         NewPageBeginPtr = XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo;
    2069     1687752 :         NewPageEndPtr = NewPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2070             : 
    2071             :         Assert(XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(NewPageBeginPtr) == nextidx);
    2072             : 
    2073     1687752 :         NewPage = (XLogPageHeader) (XLogCtl->pages + nextidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    2074             : 
    2075             :         /*
    2076             :          * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
    2077             :          * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
    2078             :          * zeroed but look valid.
    2079             :          */
    2080     1687752 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx], InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    2081     1687752 :         pg_write_barrier();
    2082             : 
    2083             :         /*
    2084             :          * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
    2085             :          * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
    2086             :          */
    2087     1687752 :         MemSet((char *) NewPage, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    2088             : 
    2089             :         /*
    2090             :          * Fill the new page's header
    2091             :          */
    2092     1687752 :         NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
    2093             : 
    2094             :         /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
    2095     1687752 :         NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
    2096     1687752 :         NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
    2097             : 
    2098             :         /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */  /* done by memset */
    2099             : 
    2100             :         /*
    2101             :          * If online backup is not in progress, mark the header to indicate
    2102             :          * that WAL records beginning in this page have removable backup
    2103             :          * blocks.  This allows the WAL archiver to know whether it is safe to
    2104             :          * compress archived WAL data by transforming full-block records into
    2105             :          * the non-full-block format.  It is sufficient to record this at the
    2106             :          * page level because we force a page switch (in fact a segment
    2107             :          * switch) when starting a backup, so the flag will be off before any
    2108             :          * records can be written during the backup.  At the end of a backup,
    2109             :          * the last page will be marked as all unsafe when perhaps only part
    2110             :          * is unsafe, but at worst the archiver would miss the opportunity to
    2111             :          * compress a few records.
    2112             :          */
    2113     1687752 :         if (Insert->runningBackups == 0)
    2114     1411488 :             NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE;
    2115             : 
    2116             :         /*
    2117             :          * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
    2118             :          */
    2119     1687752 :         if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
    2120             :         {
    2121        1328 :             XLogLongPageHeader NewLongPage = (XLogLongPageHeader) NewPage;
    2122             : 
    2123        1328 :             NewLongPage->xlp_sysid = ControlFile->system_identifier;
    2124        1328 :             NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    2125        1328 :             NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2126        1328 :             NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
    2127             :         }
    2128             : 
    2129             :         /*
    2130             :          * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
    2131             :          * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
    2132             :          * holding a lock.
    2133             :          */
    2134     1687752 :         pg_write_barrier();
    2135             : 
    2136     1687752 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx], NewPageEndPtr);
    2137     1687752 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = NewPageEndPtr;
    2138             : 
    2139     1687752 :         npages++;
    2140             :     }
    2141     1385610 :     LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
    2142             : 
    2143             : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    2144             :     if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
    2145             :     {
    2146             :         elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%X",
    2147             :              npages, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(NewPageEndPtr));
    2148             :     }
    2149             : #endif
    2150     1385610 : }
    2151             : 
    2152             : /*
    2153             :  * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
    2154             :  * checkpoint_completion_target.
    2155             :  */
    2156             : static void
    2157       12972 : CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
    2158             : {
    2159             :     double      target;
    2160             : 
    2161             :     /*-------
    2162             :      * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
    2163             :      * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
    2164             :      *
    2165             :      * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
    2166             :      *    WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
    2167             :      *    secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
    2168             :      *    only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
    2169             :      *    one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
    2170             :      *    many smaller databases.)
    2171             :      * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
    2172             :      *    number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
    2173             :      *-------
    2174             :      */
    2175       12972 :     target = (double) ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) /
    2176       12972 :         (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget);
    2177             : 
    2178             :     /* round down */
    2179       12972 :     CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
    2180             : 
    2181       12972 :     if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
    2182          18 :         CheckPointSegments = 1;
    2183       12972 : }
    2184             : 
    2185             : void
    2186        9522 : assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
    2187             : {
    2188        9522 :     max_wal_size_mb = newval;
    2189        9522 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    2190        9522 : }
    2191             : 
    2192             : void
    2193        1830 : assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
    2194             : {
    2195        1830 :     CheckPointCompletionTarget = newval;
    2196        1830 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    2197        1830 : }
    2198             : 
    2199             : bool
    2200        3532 : check_wal_segment_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    2201             : {
    2202        3532 :     if (!IsValidWalSegSize(*newval))
    2203             :     {
    2204           0 :         GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
    2205           0 :         return false;
    2206             :     }
    2207             : 
    2208        3532 :     return true;
    2209             : }
    2210             : 
    2211             : /*
    2212             :  * GUC check_hook for max_slot_wal_keep_size
    2213             :  *
    2214             :  * We don't allow the value of max_slot_wal_keep_size other than -1 during the
    2215             :  * binary upgrade. See start_postmaster() in pg_upgrade for more details.
    2216             :  */
    2217             : bool
    2218        2038 : check_max_slot_wal_keep_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    2219             : {
    2220        2038 :     if (IsBinaryUpgrade && *newval != -1)
    2221             :     {
    2222           0 :         GUC_check_errdetail("\"%s\" must be set to -1 during binary upgrade mode.",
    2223             :                             "max_slot_wal_keep_size");
    2224           0 :         return false;
    2225             :     }
    2226             : 
    2227        2038 :     return true;
    2228             : }
    2229             : 
    2230             : /*
    2231             :  * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
    2232             :  * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
    2233             :  */
    2234             : static XLogSegNo
    2235        1704 : XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
    2236             : {
    2237             :     XLogSegNo   minSegNo;
    2238             :     XLogSegNo   maxSegNo;
    2239             :     double      distance;
    2240             :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    2241             : 
    2242             :     /*
    2243             :      * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
    2244             :      * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
    2245             :      * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
    2246             :      */
    2247        1704 :     minSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
    2248        1704 :         ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
    2249        1704 :     maxSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
    2250        1704 :         ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1;
    2251             : 
    2252             :     /*
    2253             :      * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
    2254             :      * estimated end of next checkpoint.
    2255             :      *
    2256             :      * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
    2257             :      * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
    2258             :      * every checkpoint.
    2259             :      */
    2260        1704 :     distance = (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget) * CheckPointDistanceEstimate;
    2261             :     /* add 10% for good measure. */
    2262        1704 :     distance *= 1.10;
    2263             : 
    2264        1704 :     recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
    2265             :                                     wal_segment_size);
    2266             : 
    2267        1704 :     if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
    2268        1378 :         recycleSegNo = minSegNo;
    2269        1704 :     if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
    2270         128 :         recycleSegNo = maxSegNo;
    2271             : 
    2272        1704 :     return recycleSegNo;
    2273             : }
    2274             : 
    2275             : /*
    2276             :  * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
    2277             :  *
    2278             :  * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
    2279             :  * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
    2280             :  * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
    2281             :  *
    2282             :  * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
    2283             :  */
    2284             : bool
    2285        1912 : XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
    2286             : {
    2287             :     XLogSegNo   old_segno;
    2288             : 
    2289        1912 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, old_segno, wal_segment_size);
    2290             : 
    2291        1912 :     if (new_segno >= old_segno + (uint64) (CheckPointSegments - 1))
    2292         302 :         return true;
    2293        1610 :     return false;
    2294             : }
    2295             : 
    2296             : /*
    2297             :  * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
    2298             :  *
    2299             :  * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
    2300             :  * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
    2301             :  * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
    2302             :  * single one would do.
    2303             :  *
    2304             :  * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
    2305             :  * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
    2306             :  * write.
    2307             :  */
    2308             : static void
    2309     1240536 : XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
    2310             : {
    2311             :     bool        ispartialpage;
    2312             :     bool        last_iteration;
    2313             :     bool        finishing_seg;
    2314             :     int         curridx;
    2315             :     int         npages;
    2316             :     int         startidx;
    2317             :     uint32      startoffset;
    2318             : 
    2319             :     /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
    2320             :     Assert(CritSectionCount > 0);
    2321             : 
    2322             :     /*
    2323             :      * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
    2324             :      */
    2325     1240536 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2326             : 
    2327             :     /*
    2328             :      * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
    2329             :      * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
    2330             :      * write() call.  npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
    2331             :      * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
    2332             :      * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
    2333             :      * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
    2334             :      * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
    2335             :      */
    2336     1240536 :     npages = 0;
    2337     1240536 :     startidx = 0;
    2338     1240536 :     startoffset = 0;
    2339             : 
    2340             :     /*
    2341             :      * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
    2342             :      * consider writing.  Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
    2343             :      * page, or last partially written page.
    2344             :      */
    2345     1240536 :     curridx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(LogwrtResult.Write);
    2346             : 
    2347     2858038 :     while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
    2348             :     {
    2349             :         /*
    2350             :          * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process.  This could happen
    2351             :          * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
    2352             :          * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
    2353             :          */
    2354     1840028 :         XLogRecPtr  EndPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[curridx]);
    2355             : 
    2356     1840028 :         if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
    2357           0 :             elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%X is past end of log %X/%X",
    2358             :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    2359             :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPtr));
    2360             : 
    2361             :         /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
    2362     1840028 :         LogwrtResult.Write = EndPtr;
    2363     1840028 :         ispartialpage = WriteRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write;
    2364             : 
    2365     1840028 :         if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2366             :                              wal_segment_size))
    2367             :         {
    2368             :             /*
    2369             :              * Switch to new logfile segment.  We cannot have any pending
    2370             :              * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
    2371             :              */
    2372             :             Assert(npages == 0);
    2373       14226 :             if (openLogFile >= 0)
    2374        2942 :                 XLogFileClose();
    2375       14226 :             XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2376             :                             wal_segment_size);
    2377       14226 :             openLogTLI = tli;
    2378             : 
    2379             :             /* create/use new log file */
    2380       14226 :             openLogFile = XLogFileInit(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2381       14226 :             ReserveExternalFD();
    2382             :         }
    2383             : 
    2384             :         /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
    2385     1840028 :         if (openLogFile < 0)
    2386             :         {
    2387           0 :             XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2388             :                             wal_segment_size);
    2389           0 :             openLogTLI = tli;
    2390           0 :             openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2391           0 :             ReserveExternalFD();
    2392             :         }
    2393             : 
    2394             :         /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
    2395     1840028 :         if (npages == 0)
    2396             :         {
    2397             :             /* first of group */
    2398     1249796 :             startidx = curridx;
    2399     1249796 :             startoffset = XLogSegmentOffset(LogwrtResult.Write - XLOG_BLCKSZ,
    2400             :                                             wal_segment_size);
    2401             :         }
    2402     1840028 :         npages++;
    2403             : 
    2404             :         /*
    2405             :          * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
    2406             :          * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
    2407             :          * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
    2408             :          * segment.
    2409             :          */
    2410     1840028 :         last_iteration = WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Write;
    2411             : 
    2412     3459076 :         finishing_seg = !ispartialpage &&
    2413     1619048 :             (startoffset + npages * XLOG_BLCKSZ) >= wal_segment_size;
    2414             : 
    2415     1840028 :         if (last_iteration ||
    2416      599734 :             curridx == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck ||
    2417             :             finishing_seg)
    2418             :         {
    2419             :             char       *from;
    2420             :             Size        nbytes;
    2421             :             Size        nleft;
    2422             :             ssize_t     written;
    2423             :             instr_time  start;
    2424             : 
    2425             :             /* OK to write the page(s) */
    2426     1249796 :             from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2427     1249796 :             nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2428     1249796 :             nleft = nbytes;
    2429             :             do
    2430             :             {
    2431     1249796 :                 errno = 0;
    2432             : 
    2433             :                 /* Measure I/O timing to write WAL data */
    2434     1249796 :                 if (track_wal_io_timing)
    2435           0 :                     INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(start);
    2436             :                 else
    2437     1249796 :                     INSTR_TIME_SET_ZERO(start);
    2438             : 
    2439     1249796 :                 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_WRITE);
    2440     1249796 :                 written = pg_pwrite(openLogFile, from, nleft, startoffset);
    2441     1249796 :                 pgstat_report_wait_end();
    2442             : 
    2443             :                 /*
    2444             :                  * Increment the I/O timing and the number of times WAL data
    2445             :                  * were written out to disk.
    2446             :                  */
    2447     1249796 :                 if (track_wal_io_timing)
    2448             :                 {
    2449             :                     instr_time  end;
    2450             : 
    2451           0 :                     INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(end);
    2452           0 :                     INSTR_TIME_ACCUM_DIFF(PendingWalStats.wal_write_time, end, start);
    2453             :                 }
    2454             : 
    2455     1249796 :                 PendingWalStats.wal_write++;
    2456             : 
    2457     1249796 :                 if (written <= 0)
    2458             :                 {
    2459             :                     char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    2460             :                     int         save_errno;
    2461             : 
    2462           0 :                     if (errno == EINTR)
    2463           0 :                         continue;
    2464             : 
    2465           0 :                     save_errno = errno;
    2466           0 :                     XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, openLogSegNo,
    2467             :                                  wal_segment_size);
    2468           0 :                     errno = save_errno;
    2469           0 :                     ereport(PANIC,
    2470             :                             (errcode_for_file_access(),
    2471             :                              errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
    2472             :                                     xlogfname, startoffset, nleft)));
    2473             :                 }
    2474     1249796 :                 nleft -= written;
    2475     1249796 :                 from += written;
    2476     1249796 :                 startoffset += written;
    2477     1249796 :             } while (nleft > 0);
    2478             : 
    2479     1249796 :             npages = 0;
    2480             : 
    2481             :             /*
    2482             :              * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
    2483             :              * fsync the segment immediately.  This avoids having to go back
    2484             :              * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
    2485             :              * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
    2486             :              * perform this fsync.
    2487             :              *
    2488             :              * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
    2489             :              * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
    2490             :              * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
    2491             :              * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
    2492             :              * checkpoint.
    2493             :              */
    2494     1249796 :             if (finishing_seg)
    2495             :             {
    2496        1510 :                 issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo, tli);
    2497             : 
    2498             :                 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
    2499        1510 :                 WalSndWakeupRequest();
    2500             : 
    2501        1510 :                 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write;    /* end of page */
    2502             : 
    2503        1510 :                 if (XLogArchivingActive())
    2504         130 :                     XLogArchiveNotifySeg(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2505             : 
    2506        1510 :                 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    2507        1510 :                 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = LogwrtResult.Flush;
    2508             : 
    2509             :                 /*
    2510             :                  * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
    2511             :                  * the last one.  For speed, we first check using the local
    2512             :                  * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
    2513             :                  * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
    2514             :                  * recheck.
    2515             :                  */
    2516        1510 :                 if (IsUnderPostmaster && XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
    2517             :                 {
    2518         116 :                     (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
    2519         116 :                     if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo))
    2520          56 :                         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG);
    2521             :                 }
    2522             :             }
    2523             :         }
    2524             : 
    2525     1840028 :         if (ispartialpage)
    2526             :         {
    2527             :             /* Only asked to write a partial page */
    2528      220980 :             LogwrtResult.Write = WriteRqst.Write;
    2529      220980 :             break;
    2530             :         }
    2531     1619048 :         curridx = NextBufIdx(curridx);
    2532             : 
    2533             :         /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
    2534     1619048 :         if (flexible && npages == 0)
    2535        1546 :             break;
    2536             :     }
    2537             : 
    2538             :     Assert(npages == 0);
    2539             : 
    2540             :     /*
    2541             :      * If asked to flush, do so
    2542             :      */
    2543     1240536 :     if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
    2544      223002 :         LogwrtResult.Flush < LogwrtResult.Write)
    2545             :     {
    2546             :         /*
    2547             :          * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
    2548             :          * have no open file or the wrong one.  However, we do not need to
    2549             :          * fsync more than one file.
    2550             :          */
    2551      222948 :         if (wal_sync_method != WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN &&
    2552      222948 :             wal_sync_method != WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC)
    2553             :         {
    2554      222948 :             if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
    2555      222938 :                 !XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2556             :                                  wal_segment_size))
    2557           0 :                 XLogFileClose();
    2558      222948 :             if (openLogFile < 0)
    2559             :             {
    2560          10 :                 XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    2561             :                                 wal_segment_size);
    2562          10 :                 openLogTLI = tli;
    2563          10 :                 openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo, tli);
    2564          10 :                 ReserveExternalFD();
    2565             :             }
    2566             : 
    2567      222948 :             issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo, tli);
    2568             :         }
    2569             : 
    2570             :         /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
    2571      222948 :         WalSndWakeupRequest();
    2572             : 
    2573      222948 :         LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write;
    2574             :     }
    2575             : 
    2576             :     /*
    2577             :      * Update shared-memory status
    2578             :      *
    2579             :      * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
    2580             :      * 'result' values.  This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
    2581             :      * code in a couple of places.
    2582             :      */
    2583     1240536 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2584     1240536 :     if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write)
    2585      209856 :         XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = LogwrtResult.Write;
    2586     1240536 :     if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush < LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2587      223786 :         XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = LogwrtResult.Flush;
    2588     1240536 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2589             : 
    2590             :     /*
    2591             :      * We write Write first, bar, then Flush.  When reading, the opposite must
    2592             :      * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
    2593             :      * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
    2594             :      */
    2595     1240536 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, LogwrtResult.Write);
    2596     1240536 :     pg_write_barrier();
    2597     1240536 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, LogwrtResult.Flush);
    2598             : 
    2599             : #ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
    2600             :     {
    2601             :         XLogRecPtr  Flush;
    2602             :         XLogRecPtr  Write;
    2603             :         XLogRecPtr  Insert;
    2604             : 
    2605             :         Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult);
    2606             :         pg_read_barrier();
    2607             :         Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult);
    2608             :         pg_read_barrier();
    2609             :         Insert = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult);
    2610             : 
    2611             :         /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
    2612             :         Assert(Write >= Flush);
    2613             : 
    2614             :         /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
    2615             :         Assert(Insert >= Write);
    2616             :     }
    2617             : #endif
    2618     1240536 : }
    2619             : 
    2620             : /*
    2621             :  * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
    2622             :  * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
    2623             :  * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
    2624             :  */
    2625             : void
    2626       46156 : XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
    2627             : {
    2628       46156 :     XLogRecPtr  WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
    2629             :     bool        sleeping;
    2630       46156 :     bool        wakeup = false;
    2631             :     XLogRecPtr  prevAsyncXactLSN;
    2632             : 
    2633       46156 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2634       46156 :     sleeping = XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping;
    2635       46156 :     prevAsyncXactLSN = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
    2636       46156 :     if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
    2637       45450 :         XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
    2638       46156 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2639             : 
    2640             :     /*
    2641             :      * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
    2642             :      * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
    2643             :      */
    2644       46156 :     if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
    2645         706 :         return;
    2646             : 
    2647             :     /*
    2648             :      * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
    2649             :      * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
    2650             :      * amount of time.  Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
    2651             :      * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
    2652             :      */
    2653       45450 :     if (sleeping)
    2654          20 :         wakeup = true;
    2655             :     else
    2656             :     {
    2657             :         int         flushblocks;
    2658             : 
    2659       45430 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2660             : 
    2661       45430 :         flushblocks =
    2662       45430 :             WriteRqstPtr / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    2663             : 
    2664       45430 :         if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
    2665         184 :             wakeup = true;
    2666             :     }
    2667             : 
    2668       45450 :     if (wakeup && ProcGlobal->walwriterLatch)
    2669          34 :         SetLatch(ProcGlobal->walwriterLatch);
    2670             : }
    2671             : 
    2672             : /*
    2673             :  * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
    2674             :  * any replication slot.
    2675             :  */
    2676             : void
    2677       41566 : XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
    2678             : {
    2679       41566 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2680       41566 :     XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN = lsn;
    2681       41566 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2682       41566 : }
    2683             : 
    2684             : 
    2685             : /*
    2686             :  * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
    2687             :  * replication slot.
    2688             :  */
    2689             : static XLogRecPtr
    2690        2522 : XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
    2691             : {
    2692             :     XLogRecPtr  retval;
    2693             : 
    2694        2522 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2695        2522 :     retval = XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN;
    2696        2522 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2697             : 
    2698        2522 :     return retval;
    2699             : }
    2700             : 
    2701             : /*
    2702             :  * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
    2703             :  *
    2704             :  * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
    2705             :  * database is consistent.
    2706             :  *
    2707             :  * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
    2708             :  * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
    2709             :  */
    2710             : static void
    2711      178654 : UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
    2712             : {
    2713             :     /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
    2714      178654 :     if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    2715      165594 :         return;
    2716             : 
    2717             :     /*
    2718             :      * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
    2719             :      * i.e., we're doing crash recovery.  We never modify the control file's
    2720             :      * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
    2721             :      * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
    2722             :      * updated until crash recovery finishes.  We only do this for the startup
    2723             :      * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
    2724             :      * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
    2725             :      * available is replayed in this case.  This also saves from extra locks
    2726             :      * taken on the control file from the startup process.
    2727             :      */
    2728       13060 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
    2729             :     {
    2730          62 :         updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    2731          62 :         return;
    2732             :     }
    2733             : 
    2734       12998 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    2735             : 
    2736             :     /* update local copy */
    2737       12998 :     LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    2738       12998 :     LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    2739             : 
    2740       12998 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    2741           2 :         updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    2742       12996 :     else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    2743             :     {
    2744             :         XLogRecPtr  newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2745             :         TimeLineID  newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2746             : 
    2747             :         /*
    2748             :          * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
    2749             :          * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
    2750             :          * would suffice for correctness.  This also allows the 'force' case
    2751             :          * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
    2752             :          *
    2753             :          * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
    2754             :          * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
    2755             :          * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page.  Accepting such a
    2756             :          * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
    2757             :          * all.  Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
    2758             :          * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
    2759             :          */
    2760       12464 :         newMinRecoveryPoint = GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&newMinRecoveryPointTLI);
    2761       12464 :         if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    2762           0 :             elog(WARNING,
    2763             :                  "xlog min recovery request %X/%X is past current point %X/%X",
    2764             :                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint));
    2765             : 
    2766             :         /* update control file */
    2767       12464 :         if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < newMinRecoveryPoint)
    2768             :         {
    2769       12416 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2770       12416 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2771       12416 :             UpdateControlFile();
    2772       12416 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
    2773       12416 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
    2774             : 
    2775       12416 :             ereport(DEBUG2,
    2776             :                     (errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%X on timeline %u",
    2777             :                                      LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint),
    2778             :                                      newMinRecoveryPointTLI)));
    2779             :         }
    2780             :     }
    2781       12998 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    2782             : }
    2783             : 
    2784             : /*
    2785             :  * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
    2786             :  *
    2787             :  * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
    2788             :  * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
    2789             :  */
    2790             : void
    2791     1123272 : XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
    2792             : {
    2793             :     XLogRecPtr  WriteRqstPtr;
    2794             :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    2795     1123272 :     TimeLineID  insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    2796             : 
    2797             :     /*
    2798             :      * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL.  Therefore, instead of
    2799             :      * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
    2800             :      * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
    2801             :      * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
    2802             :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
    2803             :      */
    2804     1123272 :     if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
    2805             :     {
    2806      178470 :         UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
    2807      884580 :         return;
    2808             :     }
    2809             : 
    2810             :     /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
    2811      944802 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2812      706110 :         return;
    2813             : 
    2814             : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    2815             :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    2816             :         elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%X; write %X/%X; flush %X/%X",
    2817             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
    2818             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    2819             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    2820             : #endif
    2821             : 
    2822      238692 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    2823             : 
    2824             :     /*
    2825             :      * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
    2826             :      * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
    2827             :      * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
    2828             :      * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
    2829             :      * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
    2830             :      */
    2831             : 
    2832             :     /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
    2833      238692 :     WriteRqstPtr = record;
    2834             : 
    2835             :     /*
    2836             :      * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
    2837             :      * for us.
    2838             :      */
    2839             :     for (;;)
    2840        4222 :     {
    2841             :         XLogRecPtr  insertpos;
    2842             : 
    2843             :         /* done already? */
    2844      242914 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2845      242914 :         if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2846       16230 :             break;
    2847             : 
    2848             :         /*
    2849             :          * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
    2850             :          * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
    2851             :          */
    2852      226684 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2853      226684 :         if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
    2854        6732 :             WriteRqstPtr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
    2855      226684 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    2856      226684 :         insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqstPtr);
    2857             : 
    2858             :         /*
    2859             :          * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
    2860             :          * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
    2861             :          * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
    2862             :          * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
    2863             :          * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
    2864             :          */
    2865      226684 :         if (!LWLockAcquireOrWait(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE))
    2866             :         {
    2867             :             /*
    2868             :              * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
    2869             :              * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
    2870             :              * us already.
    2871             :              */
    2872        4222 :             continue;
    2873             :         }
    2874             : 
    2875             :         /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
    2876      222462 :         RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    2877      222462 :         if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    2878             :         {
    2879        1234 :             LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2880        1234 :             break;
    2881             :         }
    2882             : 
    2883             :         /*
    2884             :          * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
    2885             :          * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
    2886             :          * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
    2887             :          * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
    2888             :          *
    2889             :          * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
    2890             :          * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
    2891             :          */
    2892      221228 :         if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
    2893           0 :             MinimumActiveBackends(CommitSiblings))
    2894             :         {
    2895           0 :             pg_usleep(CommitDelay);
    2896             : 
    2897             :             /*
    2898             :              * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
    2899             :              * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
    2900             :              * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
    2901             :              * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
    2902             :              * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
    2903             :              * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
    2904             :              * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
    2905             :              * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
    2906             :              */
    2907           0 :             insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(insertpos);
    2908             :         }
    2909             : 
    2910             :         /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
    2911      221228 :         WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
    2912      221228 :         WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
    2913             : 
    2914      221228 :         XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
    2915             : 
    2916      221228 :         LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    2917             :         /* done */
    2918      221228 :         break;
    2919             :     }
    2920             : 
    2921      238692 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    2922             : 
    2923             :     /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
    2924      238692 :     WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(true, !RecoveryInProgress());
    2925             : 
    2926             :     /*
    2927             :      * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
    2928             :      * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
    2929             :      * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
    2930             :      *
    2931             :      * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
    2932             :      * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
    2933             :      * the whole system due to corruption on one data page.  In particular, if
    2934             :      * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
    2935             :      * unable to restart the database at all!  (This scenario actually
    2936             :      * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.)  As of 8.4, bad
    2937             :      * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
    2938             :      * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
    2939             :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
    2940             :      * bad LSN.
    2941             :      *
    2942             :      * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
    2943             :      * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section.  However,
    2944             :      * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
    2945             :      * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
    2946             :      */
    2947      238692 :     if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
    2948           0 :         elog(ERROR,
    2949             :              "xlog flush request %X/%X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%X",
    2950             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
    2951             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    2952             : }
    2953             : 
    2954             : /*
    2955             :  * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
    2956             :  *
    2957             :  * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
    2958             :  * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
    2959             :  * block, and write through the latest one of those.  Thus, if async commits
    2960             :  * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
    2961             :  *
    2962             :  * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
    2963             :  * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
    2964             :  * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
    2965             :  * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
    2966             :  *
    2967             :  * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
    2968             :  * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
    2969             :  * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
    2970             :  * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
    2971             :  * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
    2972             :  *
    2973             :  * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
    2974             :  *
    2975             :  * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
    2976             :  * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
    2977             :  */
    2978             : bool
    2979       27784 : XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
    2980             : {
    2981             :     XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
    2982       27784 :     bool        flexible = true;
    2983             :     static TimestampTz lastflush;
    2984             :     TimestampTz now;
    2985             :     int         flushblocks;
    2986             :     TimeLineID  insertTLI;
    2987             : 
    2988             :     /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
    2989       27784 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    2990          16 :         return false;
    2991             : 
    2992             :     /*
    2993             :      * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
    2994             :      * so we can read it without a lock.
    2995             :      */
    2996       27768 :     insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    2997             : 
    2998             :     /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
    2999       27768 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3000       27768 :     WriteRqst = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst;
    3001       27768 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3002             : 
    3003             :     /* back off to last completed page boundary */
    3004       27768 :     WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    3005             : 
    3006             :     /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
    3007       27768 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3008       27768 :     if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3009             :     {
    3010       26138 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3011       26138 :         WriteRqst.Write = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
    3012       26138 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3013       26138 :         flexible = false;       /* ensure it all gets written */
    3014             :     }
    3015             : 
    3016             :     /*
    3017             :      * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
    3018             :      * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
    3019             :      * preventing the file from being deleted.
    3020             :      */
    3021       27768 :     if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3022             :     {
    3023       25332 :         if (openLogFile >= 0)
    3024             :         {
    3025        5288 :             if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo,
    3026             :                                  wal_segment_size))
    3027             :             {
    3028         174 :                 XLogFileClose();
    3029             :             }
    3030             :         }
    3031       25332 :         return false;
    3032             :     }
    3033             : 
    3034             :     /*
    3035             :      * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
    3036             :      * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
    3037             :      *
    3038             :      * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
    3039             :      * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up.  Make sure the
    3040             :      * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
    3041             :      */
    3042        2436 :     now = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    3043        2436 :     flushblocks =
    3044        2436 :         WriteRqst.Write / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    3045             : 
    3046        2436 :     if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
    3047             :     {
    3048             :         /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
    3049         308 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3050         308 :         lastflush = now;
    3051             :     }
    3052        2128 :     else if (TimestampDifferenceExceeds(lastflush, now, WalWriterDelay))
    3053             :     {
    3054             :         /*
    3055             :          * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
    3056             :          * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
    3057             :          * commit to hit disk.
    3058             :          */
    3059        2108 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3060        2108 :         lastflush = now;
    3061             :     }
    3062          20 :     else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
    3063             :     {
    3064             :         /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
    3065          10 :         WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
    3066          10 :         lastflush = now;
    3067             :     }
    3068             :     else
    3069             :     {
    3070             :         /* no flushing, this time round */
    3071          10 :         WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
    3072             :     }
    3073             : 
    3074             : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    3075             :     if (XLOG_DEBUG)
    3076             :         elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%X; flush: %X/%X, current is write %X/%X; flush %X/%X",
    3077             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Write),
    3078             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Flush),
    3079             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write),
    3080             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush));
    3081             : #endif
    3082             : 
    3083        2436 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    3084             : 
    3085             :     /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
    3086        2436 :     WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst.Write);
    3087        2436 :     LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    3088        2436 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3089        2436 :     if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
    3090          90 :         WriteRqst.Flush > LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3091             :     {
    3092        2358 :         XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, flexible);
    3093             :     }
    3094        2436 :     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    3095             : 
    3096        2436 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    3097             : 
    3098             :     /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
    3099        2436 :     WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(true, !RecoveryInProgress());
    3100             : 
    3101             :     /*
    3102             :      * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
    3103             :      * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
    3104             :      */
    3105        2436 :     AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(InvalidXLogRecPtr, insertTLI, true);
    3106             : 
    3107             :     /*
    3108             :      * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
    3109             :      * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
    3110             :      * avoid hibernating too early.
    3111             :      */
    3112        2436 :     return true;
    3113             : }
    3114             : 
    3115             : /*
    3116             :  * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given position.
    3117             :  *
    3118             :  * Returns true if a flush is still needed.  (It may be that someone else
    3119             :  * is already in process of flushing that far, however.)
    3120             :  */
    3121             : bool
    3122    16296592 : XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
    3123             : {
    3124             :     /*
    3125             :      * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
    3126             :      * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
    3127             :      * would need to be updated.
    3128             :      */
    3129    16296592 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    3130             :     {
    3131             :         /*
    3132             :          * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
    3133             :          * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery.  We never modify the control
    3134             :          * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
    3135             :          * here too.  This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
    3136             :          * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
    3137             :          * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
    3138             :          */
    3139     1557394 :         if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery)
    3140           0 :             updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    3141             : 
    3142             :         /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
    3143     1557394 :         if (record <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint)
    3144     1520668 :             return false;
    3145             : 
    3146             :         /*
    3147             :          * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
    3148             :          * just return a conservative guess.
    3149             :          */
    3150       36726 :         if (!LWLockConditionalAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED))
    3151           0 :             return true;
    3152       36726 :         LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    3153       36726 :         LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    3154       36726 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3155             : 
    3156             :         /*
    3157             :          * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
    3158             :          * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
    3159             :          * file value if crash recovery is still running.
    3160             :          */
    3161       36726 :         if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
    3162           0 :             updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
    3163             : 
    3164             :         /* check again */
    3165       36726 :         if (record <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint)
    3166         136 :             return false;
    3167             :         else
    3168       36590 :             return true;
    3169             :     }
    3170             : 
    3171             :     /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
    3172    14739198 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3173    14318192 :         return false;
    3174             : 
    3175             :     /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
    3176      421006 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    3177             : 
    3178             :     /* check again */
    3179      421006 :     if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
    3180        3620 :         return false;
    3181             : 
    3182      417386 :     return true;
    3183             : }
    3184             : 
    3185             : /*
    3186             :  * Try to make a given XLOG file segment exist.
    3187             :  *
    3188             :  * logsegno: identify segment.
    3189             :  *
    3190             :  * *added: on return, true if this call raised the number of extant segments.
    3191             :  *
    3192             :  * path: on return, this char[MAXPGPATH] has the path to the logsegno file.
    3193             :  *
    3194             :  * Returns -1 or FD of opened file.  A -1 here is not an error; a caller
    3195             :  * wanting an open segment should attempt to open "path", which usually will
    3196             :  * succeed.  (This is weird, but it's efficient for the callers.)
    3197             :  */
    3198             : static int
    3199       14782 : XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli,
    3200             :                      bool *added, char *path)
    3201             : {
    3202             :     char        tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
    3203             :     XLogSegNo   installed_segno;
    3204             :     XLogSegNo   max_segno;
    3205             :     int         fd;
    3206             :     int         save_errno;
    3207       14782 :     int         open_flags = O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY;
    3208             : 
    3209             :     Assert(logtli != 0);
    3210             : 
    3211       14782 :     XLogFilePath(path, logtli, logsegno, wal_segment_size);
    3212             : 
    3213             :     /*
    3214             :      * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
    3215             :      */
    3216       14782 :     *added = false;
    3217       14782 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3218       14782 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3219       14782 :     if (fd < 0)
    3220             :     {
    3221         840 :         if (errno != ENOENT)
    3222           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3223             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3224             :                      errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3225             :     }
    3226             :     else
    3227       13942 :         return fd;
    3228             : 
    3229             :     /*
    3230             :      * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment.  NOTE: it is possible that
    3231             :      * another process is doing the same thing.  If so, we will end up
    3232             :      * pre-creating an extra log segment.  That seems OK, and better than
    3233             :      * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
    3234             :      */
    3235         840 :     elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
    3236             : 
    3237         840 :     snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
    3238             : 
    3239         840 :     unlink(tmppath);
    3240             : 
    3241         840 :     if (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT)
    3242           0 :         open_flags |= PG_O_DIRECT;
    3243             : 
    3244             :     /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
    3245         840 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(tmppath, open_flags);
    3246         840 :     if (fd < 0)
    3247           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3248             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3249             :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3250             : 
    3251         840 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_WRITE);
    3252         840 :     save_errno = 0;
    3253         840 :     if (wal_init_zero)
    3254             :     {
    3255             :         ssize_t     rc;
    3256             : 
    3257             :         /*
    3258             :          * Zero-fill the file.  With this setting, we do this the hard way to
    3259             :          * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated.  On
    3260             :          * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
    3261             :          * doesn't allocate intermediate space.  This way, we know that we
    3262             :          * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
    3263             :          * indirect blocks are down on disk.  Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
    3264             :          * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
    3265             :          */
    3266         840 :         rc = pg_pwrite_zeros(fd, wal_segment_size, 0);
    3267             : 
    3268         840 :         if (rc < 0)
    3269           0 :             save_errno = errno;
    3270             :     }
    3271             :     else
    3272             :     {
    3273             :         /*
    3274             :          * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
    3275             :          * enough.
    3276             :          */
    3277           0 :         errno = 0;
    3278           0 :         if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
    3279             :         {
    3280             :             /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
    3281           0 :             save_errno = errno ? errno : ENOSPC;
    3282             :         }
    3283             :     }
    3284         840 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3285             : 
    3286         840 :     if (save_errno)
    3287             :     {
    3288             :         /*
    3289             :          * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
    3290             :          */
    3291           0 :         unlink(tmppath);
    3292             : 
    3293           0 :         close(fd);
    3294             : 
    3295           0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3296             : 
    3297           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3298             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3299             :                  errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3300             :     }
    3301             : 
    3302         840 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_SYNC);
    3303         840 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    3304             :     {
    3305           0 :         save_errno = errno;
    3306           0 :         close(fd);
    3307           0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3308           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3309             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3310             :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3311             :     }
    3312         840 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3313             : 
    3314         840 :     if (close(fd) != 0)
    3315           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3316             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3317             :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3318             : 
    3319             :     /*
    3320             :      * Now move the segment into place with its final name.  Cope with
    3321             :      * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
    3322             :      * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
    3323             :      */
    3324         840 :     installed_segno = logsegno;
    3325             : 
    3326             :     /*
    3327             :      * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
    3328             :      * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
    3329             :      * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
    3330             :      * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
    3331             :      * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
    3332             :      * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
    3333             :      * CheckPointSegments.
    3334             :      */
    3335         840 :     max_segno = logsegno + CheckPointSegments;
    3336         840 :     if (InstallXLogFileSegment(&installed_segno, tmppath, true, max_segno,
    3337             :                                logtli))
    3338             :     {
    3339         840 :         *added = true;
    3340         840 :         elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
    3341             :     }
    3342             :     else
    3343             :     {
    3344             :         /*
    3345             :          * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
    3346             :          * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
    3347             :          * caller opening the file may fail.
    3348             :          */
    3349           0 :         unlink(tmppath);
    3350           0 :         elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
    3351             :     }
    3352             : 
    3353         840 :     return -1;
    3354             : }
    3355             : 
    3356             : /*
    3357             :  * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
    3358             :  *
    3359             :  * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
    3360             :  *
    3361             :  * Returns FD of opened file.
    3362             :  *
    3363             :  * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
    3364             :  * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
    3365             :  * take down the system on failure).  They will promote to PANIC if we are
    3366             :  * in a critical section.
    3367             :  */
    3368             : int
    3369       14632 : XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
    3370             : {
    3371             :     bool        ignore_added;
    3372             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3373             :     int         fd;
    3374             : 
    3375             :     Assert(logtli != 0);
    3376             : 
    3377       14632 :     fd = XLogFileInitInternal(logsegno, logtli, &ignore_added, path);
    3378       14632 :     if (fd >= 0)
    3379       13816 :         return fd;
    3380             : 
    3381             :     /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
    3382         816 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3383         816 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3384         816 :     if (fd < 0)
    3385           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3386             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3387             :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3388         816 :     return fd;
    3389             : }
    3390             : 
    3391             : /*
    3392             :  * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
    3393             :  *
    3394             :  * destsegno: identify segment to be created.
    3395             :  *
    3396             :  * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
    3397             :  *      a different timeline)
    3398             :  *
    3399             :  * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
    3400             :  *      zeros)
    3401             :  *
    3402             :  * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
    3403             :  * considerations.  But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
    3404             :  * emplacing a bogus file.
    3405             :  */
    3406             : static void
    3407          74 : XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno,
    3408             :              TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno,
    3409             :              int upto)
    3410             : {
    3411             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3412             :     char        tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
    3413             :     PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
    3414             :     int         srcfd;
    3415             :     int         fd;
    3416             :     int         nbytes;
    3417             : 
    3418             :     /*
    3419             :      * Open the source file
    3420             :      */
    3421          74 :     XLogFilePath(path, srcTLI, srcsegno, wal_segment_size);
    3422          74 :     srcfd = OpenTransientFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY);
    3423          74 :     if (srcfd < 0)
    3424           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3425             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3426             :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3427             : 
    3428             :     /*
    3429             :      * Copy into a temp file name.
    3430             :      */
    3431          74 :     snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
    3432             : 
    3433          74 :     unlink(tmppath);
    3434             : 
    3435             :     /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
    3436          74 :     fd = OpenTransientFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
    3437          74 :     if (fd < 0)
    3438           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3439             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3440             :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3441             : 
    3442             :     /*
    3443             :      * Do the data copying.
    3444             :      */
    3445      151626 :     for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
    3446             :     {
    3447             :         int         nread;
    3448             : 
    3449      151552 :         nread = upto - nbytes;
    3450             : 
    3451             :         /*
    3452             :          * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
    3453             :          * zeros.
    3454             :          */
    3455      151552 :         if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
    3456          74 :             memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
    3457             : 
    3458      151552 :         if (nread > 0)
    3459             :         {
    3460             :             int         r;
    3461             : 
    3462        5180 :             if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
    3463        5106 :                 nread = sizeof(buffer);
    3464        5180 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_READ);
    3465        5180 :             r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
    3466        5180 :             if (r != nread)
    3467             :             {
    3468           0 :                 if (r < 0)
    3469           0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3470             :                             (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3471             :                              errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
    3472             :                                     path)));
    3473             :                 else
    3474           0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    3475             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    3476             :                              errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
    3477             :                                     path, r, (Size) nread)));
    3478             :             }
    3479        5180 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3480             :         }
    3481      151552 :         errno = 0;
    3482      151552 :         pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_WRITE);
    3483      151552 :         if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
    3484             :         {
    3485           0 :             int         save_errno = errno;
    3486             : 
    3487             :             /*
    3488             :              * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
    3489             :              */
    3490           0 :             unlink(tmppath);
    3491             :             /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    3492           0 :             errno = save_errno ? save_errno : ENOSPC;
    3493             : 
    3494           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    3495             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3496             :                      errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3497             :         }
    3498      151552 :         pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3499             :     }
    3500             : 
    3501          74 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_SYNC);
    3502          74 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    3503           0 :         ereport(data_sync_elevel(ERROR),
    3504             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3505             :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3506          74 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    3507             : 
    3508          74 :     if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
    3509           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3510             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3511             :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
    3512             : 
    3513          74 :     if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
    3514           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3515             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3516             :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3517             : 
    3518             :     /*
    3519             :      * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
    3520             :      */
    3521          74 :     if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&destsegno, tmppath, false, 0, destTLI))
    3522           0 :         elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
    3523          74 : }
    3524             : 
    3525             : /*
    3526             :  * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
    3527             :  *
    3528             :  * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
    3529             :  * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
    3530             :  *
    3531             :  * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
    3532             :  * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
    3533             :  * actual installation location or last segment searched.
    3534             :  *
    3535             :  * tmppath: initial name of file to install.  It will be renamed into place.
    3536             :  *
    3537             :  * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
    3538             :  * number at or after the passed numbers.  If false, install the new segment
    3539             :  * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
    3540             :  *
    3541             :  * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as.  Fail if no
    3542             :  * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
    3543             :  * is false.)
    3544             :  *
    3545             :  * tli: The timeline on which the new segment should be installed.
    3546             :  *
    3547             :  * Returns true if the file was installed successfully.  false indicates that
    3548             :  * max_segno limit was exceeded, the startup process has disabled this
    3549             :  * function for now, or an error occurred while renaming the file into place.
    3550             :  */
    3551             : static bool
    3552        2100 : InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
    3553             :                        bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3554             : {
    3555             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3556             :     struct stat stat_buf;
    3557             : 
    3558             :     Assert(tli != 0);
    3559             : 
    3560        2100 :     XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
    3561             : 
    3562        2100 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    3563        2100 :     if (!XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive)
    3564             :     {
    3565           0 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3566           0 :         return false;
    3567             :     }
    3568             : 
    3569        2100 :     if (!find_free)
    3570             :     {
    3571             :         /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
    3572          74 :         durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
    3573             :     }
    3574             :     else
    3575             :     {
    3576             :         /* Find a free slot to put it in */
    3577        3278 :         while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    3578             :         {
    3579        1284 :             if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
    3580             :             {
    3581             :                 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
    3582          32 :                 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3583          32 :                 return false;
    3584             :             }
    3585        1252 :             (*segno)++;
    3586        1252 :             XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
    3587             :         }
    3588             :     }
    3589             : 
    3590             :     Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
    3591        2068 :     if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
    3592             :     {
    3593           0 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3594             :         /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
    3595           0 :         return false;
    3596             :     }
    3597             : 
    3598        2068 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    3599             : 
    3600        2068 :     return true;
    3601             : }
    3602             : 
    3603             : /*
    3604             :  * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
    3605             :  */
    3606             : int
    3607          10 : XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3608             : {
    3609             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3610             :     int         fd;
    3611             : 
    3612          10 :     XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3613             : 
    3614          10 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
    3615          10 :                        get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method));
    3616          10 :     if (fd < 0)
    3617           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    3618             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3619             :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
    3620             : 
    3621          10 :     return fd;
    3622             : }
    3623             : 
    3624             : /*
    3625             :  * Close the current logfile segment for writing.
    3626             :  */
    3627             : static void
    3628        3116 : XLogFileClose(void)
    3629             : {
    3630             :     Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
    3631             : 
    3632             :     /*
    3633             :      * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
    3634             :      * the OS to release any cached pages.  But do not do so if WAL archiving
    3635             :      * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
    3636             :      * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
    3637             :      */
    3638             : #if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
    3639        3116 :     if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
    3640        2144 :         (void) posix_fadvise(openLogFile, 0, 0, POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED);
    3641             : #endif
    3642             : 
    3643        3116 :     if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
    3644             :     {
    3645             :         char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3646           0 :         int         save_errno = errno;
    3647             : 
    3648           0 :         XLogFileName(xlogfname, openLogTLI, openLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3649           0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3650           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    3651             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3652             :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    3653             :     }
    3654             : 
    3655        3116 :     openLogFile = -1;
    3656        3116 :     ReleaseExternalFD();
    3657        3116 : }
    3658             : 
    3659             : /*
    3660             :  * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
    3661             :  *
    3662             :  * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
    3663             :  * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
    3664             :  * the current one.  This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
    3665             :  * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
    3666             :  * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
    3667             :  * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
    3668             :  *
    3669             :  * XLogFileInitInternal() can ereport(ERROR).  All known causes indicate big
    3670             :  * trouble; for example, a full filesystem is one cause.  The checkpoint WAL
    3671             :  * and/or ControlFile updates already completed.  If a RequestCheckpoint()
    3672             :  * initiated the present checkpoint and an ERROR ends this function, the
    3673             :  * command that called RequestCheckpoint() fails.  That's not ideal, but it's
    3674             :  * not worth contorting more functions to use caller-specified elevel values.
    3675             :  * (With or without RequestCheckpoint(), an ERROR forestalls some inessential
    3676             :  * reporting and resource reclamation.)
    3677             :  */
    3678             : static void
    3679        2162 : PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
    3680             : {
    3681             :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    3682             :     int         lf;
    3683             :     bool        added;
    3684             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3685             :     uint64      offset;
    3686             : 
    3687        2162 :     if (!XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive)
    3688           8 :         return;                 /* unlocked check says no */
    3689             : 
    3690        2154 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(endptr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3691        2154 :     offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
    3692        2154 :     if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
    3693             :     {
    3694         150 :         _logSegNo++;
    3695         150 :         lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
    3696         150 :         if (lf >= 0)
    3697         126 :             close(lf);
    3698         150 :         if (added)
    3699          24 :             CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added++;
    3700             :     }
    3701             : }
    3702             : 
    3703             : /*
    3704             :  * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
    3705             :  * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
    3706             :  * existed while the server has been running, as this function always
    3707             :  * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
    3708             :  * 'tli' is only used in the error message.
    3709             :  *
    3710             :  * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
    3711             :  * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
    3712             :  * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
    3713             :  * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
    3714             :  */
    3715             : void
    3716      102062 : CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    3717             : {
    3718      102062 :     int         save_errno = errno;
    3719             :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;
    3720             : 
    3721      102062 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3722      102062 :     lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
    3723      102062 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3724             : 
    3725      102062 :     if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
    3726             :     {
    3727             :         char        filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3728             : 
    3729           0 :         XLogFileName(filename, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3730           0 :         errno = save_errno;
    3731           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    3732             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    3733             :                  errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
    3734             :                         filename)));
    3735             :     }
    3736      102062 :     errno = save_errno;
    3737      102062 : }
    3738             : 
    3739             : /*
    3740             :  * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
    3741             :  * since startup.
    3742             :  *
    3743             :  * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
    3744             :  * with that.
    3745             :  */
    3746             : XLogSegNo
    3747        1860 : XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
    3748             : {
    3749             :     XLogSegNo   lastRemovedSegNo;
    3750             : 
    3751        1860 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3752        1860 :     lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
    3753        1860 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3754             : 
    3755        1860 :     return lastRemovedSegNo;
    3756             : }
    3757             : 
    3758             : /*
    3759             :  * Return the oldest WAL segment on the given TLI that still exists in
    3760             :  * XLOGDIR, or 0 if none.
    3761             :  */
    3762             : XLogSegNo
    3763           4 : XLogGetOldestSegno(TimeLineID tli)
    3764             : {
    3765             :     DIR        *xldir;
    3766             :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3767           4 :     XLogSegNo   oldest_segno = 0;
    3768             : 
    3769           4 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3770          28 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3771             :     {
    3772             :         TimeLineID  file_tli;
    3773             :         XLogSegNo   file_segno;
    3774             : 
    3775             :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
    3776          24 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3777          16 :             continue;
    3778             : 
    3779             :         /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
    3780           8 :         XLogFromFileName(xlde->d_name, &file_tli, &file_segno,
    3781             :                          wal_segment_size);
    3782             : 
    3783             :         /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
    3784           8 :         if (tli != file_tli)
    3785           0 :             continue;
    3786             : 
    3787             :         /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
    3788           8 :         if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
    3789           8 :             oldest_segno = file_segno;
    3790             :     }
    3791             : 
    3792           4 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3793           4 :     return oldest_segno;
    3794             : }
    3795             : 
    3796             : /*
    3797             :  * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
    3798             :  * given XLOG file has been removed.
    3799             :  */
    3800             : static void
    3801        1212 : UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
    3802             : {
    3803             :     uint32      tli;
    3804             :     XLogSegNo   segno;
    3805             : 
    3806        1212 :     XLogFromFileName(filename, &tli, &segno, wal_segment_size);
    3807             : 
    3808        1212 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3809        1212 :     if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
    3810         450 :         XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
    3811        1212 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    3812        1212 : }
    3813             : 
    3814             : /*
    3815             :  * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
    3816             :  *
    3817             :  * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
    3818             :  * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
    3819             :  */
    3820             : static void
    3821         326 : RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
    3822             : {
    3823             :     DIR        *xldir;
    3824             :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3825             : 
    3826         326 :     elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
    3827             : 
    3828         326 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3829        2068 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3830             :     {
    3831             :         char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    3832             : 
    3833        1742 :         if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
    3834        1742 :             continue;
    3835             : 
    3836           0 :         snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
    3837           0 :         unlink(path);
    3838           0 :         elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
    3839             :     }
    3840         326 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3841         326 : }
    3842             : 
    3843             : /*
    3844             :  * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
    3845             :  *
    3846             :  * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
    3847             :  * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
    3848             :  * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
    3849             :  *
    3850             :  * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled
    3851             :  * segments should be reused for this timeline.
    3852             :  */
    3853             : static void
    3854        1704 : RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr,
    3855             :                    TimeLineID insertTLI)
    3856             : {
    3857             :     DIR        *xldir;
    3858             :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3859             :     char        lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3860             :     XLogSegNo   endlogSegNo;
    3861             :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    3862             : 
    3863             :     /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
    3864        1704 :     XLByteToSeg(endptr, endlogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3865        1704 :     recycleSegNo = XLOGfileslop(lastredoptr);
    3866             : 
    3867             :     /*
    3868             :      * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
    3869             :      * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
    3870             :      * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
    3871             :      */
    3872        1704 :     XLogFileName(lastoff, 0, segno, wal_segment_size);
    3873             : 
    3874        1704 :     elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
    3875             :          lastoff);
    3876             : 
    3877        1704 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3878             : 
    3879       14874 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3880             :     {
    3881             :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
    3882       13170 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
    3883        6964 :             !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3884        6960 :             continue;
    3885             : 
    3886             :         /*
    3887             :          * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
    3888             :          * deciding whether a segment is still needed.  This ensures that we
    3889             :          * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
    3890             :          * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
    3891             :          * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
    3892             :          * complicated.
    3893             :          *
    3894             :          * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
    3895             :          * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
    3896             :          */
    3897        6210 :         if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
    3898             :         {
    3899        1228 :             if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
    3900             :             {
    3901             :                 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
    3902        1212 :                 UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
    3903             : 
    3904        1212 :                 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endlogSegNo, insertTLI);
    3905             :             }
    3906             :         }
    3907             :     }
    3908             : 
    3909        1704 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3910        1704 : }
    3911             : 
    3912             : /*
    3913             :  * Recycle or remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's
    3914             :  * history.
    3915             :  *
    3916             :  * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
    3917             :  * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
    3918             :  * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
    3919             :  * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
    3920             :  * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
    3921             :  * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
    3922             :  * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
    3923             :  * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
    3924             :  *
    3925             :  * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
    3926             :  * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
    3927             :  */
    3928             : void
    3929         110 : RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
    3930             : {
    3931             :     DIR        *xldir;
    3932             :     struct dirent *xlde;
    3933             :     char        switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
    3934             :     XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    3935             :     XLogSegNo   switchLogSegNo;
    3936             :     XLogSegNo   recycleSegNo;
    3937             : 
    3938             :     /*
    3939             :      * Initialize info about where to begin the work.  This will recycle,
    3940             :      * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
    3941             :      */
    3942         110 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(switchpoint, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3943         110 :     XLByteToSeg(switchpoint, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3944         110 :     recycleSegNo = endLogSegNo + 10;
    3945             : 
    3946             :     /*
    3947             :      * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
    3948             :      */
    3949         110 :     XLogFileName(switchseg, newTLI, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    3950             : 
    3951         110 :     elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
    3952             :          switchseg);
    3953             : 
    3954         110 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    3955             : 
    3956        1052 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    3957             :     {
    3958             :         /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
    3959         942 :         if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
    3960         586 :             continue;
    3961             : 
    3962             :         /*
    3963             :          * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
    3964             :          * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
    3965             :          * new timeline.
    3966             :          */
    3967         356 :         if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
    3968         232 :             strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
    3969             :         {
    3970             :             /*
    3971             :              * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
    3972             :              * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
    3973             :              * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
    3974             :              * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
    3975             :              */
    3976          34 :             if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
    3977          34 :                 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endLogSegNo, newTLI);
    3978             :         }
    3979             :     }
    3980             : 
    3981         110 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    3982         110 : }
    3983             : 
    3984             : /*
    3985             :  * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
    3986             :  *
    3987             :  * segment_de is the dirent structure of the segment to recycle or remove.
    3988             :  * recycleSegNo is the segment number to recycle up to.  endlogSegNo is
    3989             :  * the segment number of the current (or recent) end of WAL.
    3990             :  *
    3991             :  * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not
    3992             :  * checked again with future callers of this function.
    3993             :  *
    3994             :  * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled segments
    3995             :  * should be used for this timeline.
    3996             :  */
    3997             : static void
    3998        1246 : RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
    3999             :                XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo,
    4000             :                TimeLineID insertTLI)
    4001             : {
    4002             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    4003             : #ifdef WIN32
    4004             :     char        newpath[MAXPGPATH];
    4005             : #endif
    4006        1246 :     const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
    4007             : 
    4008        1246 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
    4009             : 
    4010             :     /*
    4011             :      * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
    4012             :      * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
    4013             :      * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
    4014             :      */
    4015        1246 :     if (wal_recycle &&
    4016        1246 :         *endlogSegNo <= recycleSegNo &&
    4017        2380 :         XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
    4018        2372 :         get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
    4019        1186 :         InstallXLogFileSegment(endlogSegNo, path,
    4020             :                                true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
    4021             :     {
    4022        1154 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    4023             :                 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
    4024             :                                  segname)));
    4025        1154 :         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled++;
    4026             :         /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
    4027        1154 :         (*endlogSegNo)++;
    4028             :     }
    4029             :     else
    4030             :     {
    4031             :         /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
    4032             :         int         rc;
    4033             : 
    4034          92 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    4035             :                 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
    4036             :                                  segname)));
    4037             : 
    4038             : #ifdef WIN32
    4039             : 
    4040             :         /*
    4041             :          * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
    4042             :          * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
    4043             :          * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
    4044             :          * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
    4045             :          * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
    4046             :          *
    4047             :          * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
    4048             :          * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
    4049             :          */
    4050             :         snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
    4051             :         if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
    4052             :         {
    4053             :             ereport(LOG,
    4054             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4055             :                      errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
    4056             :                             path)));
    4057             :             return;
    4058             :         }
    4059             :         rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
    4060             : #else
    4061          92 :         rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
    4062             : #endif
    4063          92 :         if (rc != 0)
    4064             :         {
    4065             :             /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
    4066           0 :             return;
    4067             :         }
    4068          92 :         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed++;
    4069             :     }
    4070             : 
    4071        1246 :     XLogArchiveCleanup(segname);
    4072             : }
    4073             : 
    4074             : /*
    4075             :  * Verify whether pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
    4076             :  * If the latter do not exist, recreate them.
    4077             :  *
    4078             :  * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
    4079             :  * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
    4080             :  * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
    4081             :  *
    4082             :  * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
    4083             :  * policy decision was made not to.  It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
    4084             :  * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
    4085             :  * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
    4086             :  */
    4087             : static void
    4088        1520 : ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
    4089             : {
    4090             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH];
    4091             :     struct stat stat_buf;
    4092             : 
    4093             :     /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
    4094        1520 :     if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
    4095        1520 :         !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4096           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4097             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4098             :                  errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4099             :                         XLOGDIR)));
    4100             : 
    4101             :     /* Check for archive_status */
    4102        1520 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
    4103        1520 :     if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    4104             :     {
    4105             :         /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
    4106        1518 :         if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4107           0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4108             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4109             :                      errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4110             :                             path)));
    4111             :     }
    4112             :     else
    4113             :     {
    4114           2 :         ereport(LOG,
    4115             :                 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
    4116           2 :         if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
    4117           0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4118             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4119             :                      errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
    4120             :                             path)));
    4121             :     }
    4122             : 
    4123             :     /* Check for summaries */
    4124        1520 :     snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
    4125        1520 :     if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
    4126             :     {
    4127             :         /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
    4128        1518 :         if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
    4129           0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4130             :                     (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
    4131             :                             path)));
    4132             :     }
    4133             :     else
    4134             :     {
    4135           2 :         ereport(LOG,
    4136             :                 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
    4137           2 :         if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
    4138           0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    4139             :                     (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
    4140             :                             path)));
    4141             :     }
    4142        1520 : }
    4143             : 
    4144             : /*
    4145             :  * Remove previous backup history files.  This also retries creation of
    4146             :  * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
    4147             :  * failed earlier.
    4148             :  */
    4149             : static void
    4150         260 : CleanupBackupHistory(void)
    4151             : {
    4152             :     DIR        *xldir;
    4153             :     struct dirent *xlde;
    4154             :     char        path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
    4155             : 
    4156         260 :     xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
    4157             : 
    4158        2354 :     while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
    4159             :     {
    4160        2094 :         if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
    4161             :         {
    4162         274 :             if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
    4163             :             {
    4164         224 :                 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
    4165             :                      xlde->d_name);
    4166         224 :                 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
    4167         224 :                 unlink(path);
    4168         224 :                 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
    4169             :             }
    4170             :         }
    4171             :     }
    4172             : 
    4173         260 :     FreeDir(xldir);
    4174         260 : }
    4175             : 
    4176             : /*
    4177             :  * I/O routines for pg_control
    4178             :  *
    4179             :  * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
    4180             :  * contents of pg_control.  WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
    4181             :  * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
    4182             :  * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
    4183             :  * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
    4184             :  * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
    4185             :  *
    4186             :  * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
    4187             :  * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
    4188             :  * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct.  We could split out the
    4189             :  * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
    4190             :  */
    4191             : 
    4192             : static void
    4193          80 : InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier)
    4194             : {
    4195             :     char        mock_auth_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN];
    4196             : 
    4197             :     /*
    4198             :      * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
    4199             :      * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
    4200             :      * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
    4201             :      * of an actual stored password.
    4202             :      */
    4203          80 :     if (!pg_strong_random(mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN))
    4204           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4205             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR),
    4206             :                  errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
    4207             : 
    4208          80 :     memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4209             :     /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
    4210          80 :     ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
    4211          80 :     memcpy(ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce, mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN);
    4212          80 :     ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
    4213          80 :     ControlFile->unloggedLSN = FirstNormalUnloggedLSN;
    4214             : 
    4215             :     /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
    4216          80 :     ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    4217          80 :     ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    4218          80 :     ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    4219          80 :     ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    4220          80 :     ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    4221          80 :     ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
    4222          80 :     ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    4223          80 :     ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    4224          80 :     ControlFile->data_checksum_version = bootstrap_data_checksum_version;
    4225          80 : }
    4226             : 
    4227             : static void
    4228          80 : WriteControlFile(void)
    4229             : {
    4230             :     int         fd;
    4231             :     char        buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE];   /* need not be aligned */
    4232             : 
    4233             :     /*
    4234             :      * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
    4235             :      */
    4236          80 :     ControlFile->pg_control_version = PG_CONTROL_VERSION;
    4237          80 :     ControlFile->catalog_version_no = CATALOG_VERSION_NO;
    4238             : 
    4239          80 :     ControlFile->maxAlign = MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF;
    4240          80 :     ControlFile->floatFormat = FLOATFORMAT_VALUE;
    4241             : 
    4242          80 :     ControlFile->blcksz = BLCKSZ;
    4243          80 :     ControlFile->relseg_size = RELSEG_SIZE;
    4244          80 :     ControlFile->xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    4245          80 :     ControlFile->xlog_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    4246             : 
    4247          80 :     ControlFile->nameDataLen = NAMEDATALEN;
    4248          80 :     ControlFile->indexMaxKeys = INDEX_MAX_KEYS;
    4249             : 
    4250          80 :     ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size = TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE;
    4251          80 :     ControlFile->loblksize = LOBLKSIZE;
    4252             : 
    4253          80 :     ControlFile->float8ByVal = FLOAT8PASSBYVAL;
    4254             : 
    4255             :     /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
    4256          80 :     INIT_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
    4257          80 :     COMP_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc,
    4258             :                 (char *) ControlFile,
    4259             :                 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
    4260          80 :     FIN_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc);
    4261             : 
    4262             :     /*
    4263             :      * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
    4264             :      * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData).  This reduces the odds of
    4265             :      * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control.  We'll still fail when we
    4266             :      * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
    4267             :      * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
    4268             :      */
    4269          80 :     memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
    4270          80 :     memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4271             : 
    4272          80 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
    4273             :                        O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
    4274          80 :     if (fd < 0)
    4275           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4276             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4277             :                  errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
    4278             :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4279             : 
    4280          80 :     errno = 0;
    4281          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_WRITE);
    4282          80 :     if (write(fd, buffer, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE) != PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE)
    4283             :     {
    4284             :         /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    4285           0 :         if (errno == 0)
    4286           0 :             errno = ENOSPC;
    4287           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4288             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4289             :                  errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
    4290             :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4291             :     }
    4292          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4293             : 
    4294          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_SYNC);
    4295          80 :     if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
    4296           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4297             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4298             :                  errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
    4299             :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4300          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4301             : 
    4302          80 :     if (close(fd) != 0)
    4303           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4304             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4305             :                  errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
    4306             :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4307          80 : }
    4308             : 
    4309             : static void
    4310        1620 : ReadControlFile(void)
    4311             : {
    4312             :     pg_crc32c   crc;
    4313             :     int         fd;
    4314             :     static char wal_segsz_str[20];
    4315             :     int         r;
    4316             : 
    4317             :     /*
    4318             :      * Read data...
    4319             :      */
    4320        1620 :     fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE,
    4321             :                        O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
    4322        1620 :     if (fd < 0)
    4323           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    4324             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4325             :                  errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
    4326             :                         XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4327             : 
    4328        1620 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_READ);
    4329        1620 :     r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4330        1620 :     if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
    4331             :     {
    4332           0 :         if (r < 0)
    4333           0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    4334             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    4335             :                      errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
    4336             :                             XLOG_CONTROL_FILE)));
    4337             :         else
    4338           0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    4339             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    4340             :                      errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
    4341             :                             XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
    4342             :     }
    4343        1620 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    4344             : 
    4345        1620 :     close(fd);
    4346             : 
    4347             :     /*
    4348             :      * Check for expected pg_control format version.  If this is wrong, the
    4349             :      * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
    4350             :      * of bytes.  Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
    4351             :      * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
    4352             :      */
    4353             : 
    4354        1620 :     if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION && ControlFile->pg_control_version % 65536 == 0 && ControlFile->pg_control_version / 65536 != 0)
    4355           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4356             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4357             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4358             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
    4359             :                            " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
    4360             :                            ControlFile->pg_control_version, ControlFile->pg_control_version,
    4361             :                            PG_CONTROL_VERSION, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
    4362             :                  errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering.  It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4363             : 
    4364        1620 :     if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION)
    4365           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4366             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4367             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4368             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
    4369             :                            " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
    4370             :                            ControlFile->pg_control_version, PG_CONTROL_VERSION),
    4371             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4372             : 
    4373             :     /* Now check the CRC. */
    4374        1620 :     INIT_CRC32C(crc);
    4375        1620 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc,
    4376             :                 (char *) ControlFile,
    4377             :                 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
    4378        1620 :     FIN_CRC32C(crc);
    4379             : 
    4380        1620 :     if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
    4381           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4382             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4383             :                  errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
    4384             : 
    4385             :     /*
    4386             :      * Do compatibility checking immediately.  If the database isn't
    4387             :      * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
    4388             :      * possibly do any damage.
    4389             :      */
    4390        1620 :     if (ControlFile->catalog_version_no != CATALOG_VERSION_NO)
    4391           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4392             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4393             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4394             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with CATALOG_VERSION_NO %d,"
    4395             :                            " but the server was compiled with CATALOG_VERSION_NO %d.",
    4396             :                            ControlFile->catalog_version_no, CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
    4397             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4398        1620 :     if (ControlFile->maxAlign != MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF)
    4399           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4400             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4401             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4402             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with MAXALIGN %d,"
    4403             :                            " but the server was compiled with MAXALIGN %d.",
    4404             :                            ControlFile->maxAlign, MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
    4405             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4406        1620 :     if (ControlFile->floatFormat != FLOATFORMAT_VALUE)
    4407           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4408             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4409             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4410             :                  errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
    4411             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
    4412        1620 :     if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
    4413           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4414             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4415             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4416             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with BLCKSZ %d,"
    4417             :                            " but the server was compiled with BLCKSZ %d.",
    4418             :                            ControlFile->blcksz, BLCKSZ),
    4419             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4420        1620 :     if (ControlFile->relseg_size != RELSEG_SIZE)
    4421           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4422             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4423             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4424             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with RELSEG_SIZE %d,"
    4425             :                            " but the server was compiled with RELSEG_SIZE %d.",
    4426             :                            ControlFile->relseg_size, RELSEG_SIZE),
    4427             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4428        1620 :     if (ControlFile->xlog_blcksz != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    4429           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4430             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4431             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4432             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with XLOG_BLCKSZ %d,"
    4433             :                            " but the server was compiled with XLOG_BLCKSZ %d.",
    4434             :                            ControlFile->xlog_blcksz, XLOG_BLCKSZ),
    4435             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4436        1620 :     if (ControlFile->nameDataLen != NAMEDATALEN)
    4437           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4438             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4439             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4440             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with NAMEDATALEN %d,"
    4441             :                            " but the server was compiled with NAMEDATALEN %d.",
    4442             :                            ControlFile->nameDataLen, NAMEDATALEN),
    4443             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4444        1620 :     if (ControlFile->indexMaxKeys != INDEX_MAX_KEYS)
    4445           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4446             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4447             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4448             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with INDEX_MAX_KEYS %d,"
    4449             :                            " but the server was compiled with INDEX_MAX_KEYS %d.",
    4450             :                            ControlFile->indexMaxKeys, INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
    4451             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4452        1620 :     if (ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size != TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE)
    4453           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4454             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4455             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4456             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE %d,"
    4457             :                            " but the server was compiled with TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE %d.",
    4458             :                            ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size, (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
    4459             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4460        1620 :     if (ControlFile->loblksize != LOBLKSIZE)
    4461           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4462             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4463             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4464             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with LOBLKSIZE %d,"
    4465             :                            " but the server was compiled with LOBLKSIZE %d.",
    4466             :                            ControlFile->loblksize, (int) LOBLKSIZE),
    4467             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4468             : 
    4469             : #ifdef USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL
    4470        1620 :     if (ControlFile->float8ByVal != true)
    4471           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    4472             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4473             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4474             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized without USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL"
    4475             :                            " but the server was compiled with USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL."),
    4476             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4477             : #else
    4478             :     if (ControlFile->float8ByVal != false)
    4479             :         ereport(FATAL,
    4480             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    4481             :                  errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
    4482             :                  errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL"
    4483             :                            " but the server was compiled without USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL."),
    4484             :                  errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
    4485             : #endif
    4486             : 
    4487        1620 :     wal_segment_size = ControlFile->xlog_seg_size;
    4488             : 
    4489        1620 :     if (!IsValidWalSegSize(wal_segment_size))
    4490           0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4491             :                         errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
    4492             :                                       "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
    4493             :                                       wal_segment_size,
    4494             :                                       wal_segment_size),
    4495             :                         errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
    4496             : 
    4497        1620 :     snprintf(wal_segsz_str, sizeof(wal_segsz_str), "%d", wal_segment_size);
    4498        1620 :     SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
    4499             :                     PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4500             : 
    4501             :     /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
    4502        1620 :     if (ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
    4503           0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4504             :                         errmsg("min_wal_size must be at least twice wal_segment_size")));
    4505             : 
    4506        1620 :     if (ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2)
    4507           0 :         ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    4508             :                         errmsg("max_wal_size must be at least twice wal_segment_size")));
    4509             : 
    4510        1620 :     UsableBytesInSegment =
    4511        1620 :         (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ * UsableBytesInPage) -
    4512             :         (SizeOfXLogLongPHD - SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
    4513             : 
    4514        1620 :     CalculateCheckpointSegments();
    4515             : 
    4516             :     /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
    4517        1620 :     SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
    4518             :                     PGC_INTERNAL, PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4519        1620 : }
    4520             : 
    4521             : /*
    4522             :  * Utility wrapper to update the control file.  Note that the control
    4523             :  * file gets flushed.
    4524             :  */
    4525             : static void
    4526       17934 : UpdateControlFile(void)
    4527             : {
    4528       17934 :     update_controlfile(DataDir, ControlFile, true);
    4529       17934 : }
    4530             : 
    4531             : /*
    4532             :  * Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
    4533             :  */
    4534             : uint64
    4535        2402 : GetSystemIdentifier(void)
    4536             : {
    4537             :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4538        2402 :     return ControlFile->system_identifier;
    4539             : }
    4540             : 
    4541             : /*
    4542             :  * Returns the random nonce from control file.
    4543             :  */
    4544             : char *
    4545           2 : GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
    4546             : {
    4547             :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4548           2 :     return ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce;
    4549             : }
    4550             : 
    4551             : /*
    4552             :  * Are checksums enabled for data pages?
    4553             :  */
    4554             : bool
    4555    19439700 : DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
    4556             : {
    4557             :     Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
    4558    19439700 :     return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0);
    4559             : }
    4560             : 
    4561             : /*
    4562             :  * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
    4563             :  *
    4564             :  * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
    4565             :  * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
    4566             :  * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
    4567             :  * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
    4568             :  * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
    4569             :  */
    4570             : XLogRecPtr
    4571          66 : GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
    4572             : {
    4573          66 :     return pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN, 1);
    4574             : }
    4575             : 
    4576             : /*
    4577             :  * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
    4578             :  *
    4579             :  * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
    4580             :  * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
    4581             :  * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
    4582             :  * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
    4583             :  * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
    4584             :  *
    4585             :  * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
    4586             :  */
    4587             : static int
    4588        1766 : XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
    4589             : {
    4590             :     int         xbuffers;
    4591             : 
    4592        1766 :     xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
    4593        1766 :     if (xbuffers > (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ))
    4594          42 :         xbuffers = (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    4595        1766 :     if (xbuffers < 8)
    4596         708 :         xbuffers = 8;
    4597        1766 :     return xbuffers;
    4598             : }
    4599             : 
    4600             : /*
    4601             :  * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
    4602             :  */
    4603             : bool
    4604        3596 : check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    4605             : {
    4606             :     /*
    4607             :      * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
    4608             :      */
    4609        3596 :     if (*newval == -1)
    4610             :     {
    4611             :         /*
    4612             :          * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
    4613             :          * be.  We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
    4614             :          */
    4615        1830 :         if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
    4616        1830 :             return true;
    4617             : 
    4618             :         /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
    4619           0 :         *newval = XLOGChooseNumBuffers();
    4620             :     }
    4621             : 
    4622             :     /*
    4623             :      * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks.  Prior to PostgreSQL
    4624             :      * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
    4625             :      * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
    4626             :      * minimum.  (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
    4627             :      * helpful.)
    4628             :      */
    4629        1766 :     if (*newval < 4)
    4630           0 :         *newval = 4;
    4631             : 
    4632        1766 :     return true;
    4633             : }
    4634             : 
    4635             : /*
    4636             :  * GUC check_hook for wal_consistency_checking
    4637             :  */
    4638             : bool
    4639        1834 : check_wal_consistency_checking(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
    4640             : {
    4641             :     char       *rawstring;
    4642             :     List       *elemlist;
    4643             :     ListCell   *l;
    4644             :     bool        newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
    4645             : 
    4646             :     /* Initialize the array */
    4647       60522 :     MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4648             : 
    4649             :     /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
    4650        1834 :     rawstring = pstrdup(*newval);
    4651             : 
    4652             :     /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
    4653        1834 :     if (!SplitIdentifierString(rawstring, ',', &elemlist))
    4654             :     {
    4655             :         /* syntax error in list */
    4656           0 :         GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
    4657           0 :         pfree(rawstring);
    4658           0 :         list_free(elemlist);
    4659           0 :         return false;
    4660             :     }
    4661             : 
    4662        1838 :     foreach(l, elemlist)
    4663             :     {
    4664           4 :         char       *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
    4665             :         int         rmid;
    4666             : 
    4667             :         /* Check for 'all'. */
    4668           4 :         if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
    4669             :         {
    4670           0 :             for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
    4671           0 :                 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
    4672           0 :                     newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
    4673             :         }
    4674             :         else
    4675             :         {
    4676             :             /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
    4677           4 :             bool        found = false;
    4678             : 
    4679          72 :             for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
    4680             :             {
    4681         108 :                 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
    4682          36 :                     pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
    4683             :                 {
    4684           4 :                     newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
    4685           4 :                     found = true;
    4686           4 :                     break;
    4687             :                 }
    4688             :             }
    4689           4 :             if (!found)
    4690             :             {
    4691             :                 /*
    4692             :                  * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
    4693             :                  * resource manager.  Defer checking until
    4694             :                  * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
    4695             :                  */
    4696           0 :                 if (!process_shared_preload_libraries_done)
    4697             :                 {
    4698           0 :                     check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = true;
    4699             :                 }
    4700             :                 else
    4701             :                 {
    4702           0 :                     GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
    4703           0 :                     pfree(rawstring);
    4704           0 :                     list_free(elemlist);
    4705           0 :                     return false;
    4706             :                 }
    4707             :             }
    4708             :         }
    4709             :     }
    4710             : 
    4711        1834 :     pfree(rawstring);
    4712        1834 :     list_free(elemlist);
    4713             : 
    4714             :     /* assign new value */
    4715        1834 :     *extra = guc_malloc(ERROR, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4716        1834 :     memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
    4717        1834 :     return true;
    4718             : }
    4719             : 
    4720             : /*
    4721             :  * GUC assign_hook for wal_consistency_checking
    4722             :  */
    4723             : void
    4724        1834 : assign_wal_consistency_checking(const char *newval, void *extra)
    4725             : {
    4726             :     /*
    4727             :      * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
    4728             :      * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
    4729             :      * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
    4730             :      * assignment.
    4731             :      *
    4732             :      * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
    4733             :      * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
    4734             :      * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
    4735             :      * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
    4736             :      * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
    4737             :      * module is loaded anyway.
    4738             :      */
    4739        1834 :     wal_consistency_checking = extra;
    4740        1834 : }
    4741             : 
    4742             : /*
    4743             :  * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking: run after loading custom resource managers
    4744             :  *
    4745             :  * If any unknown resource managers were specified in the
    4746             :  * wal_consistency_checking GUC, processing was deferred.  Now that
    4747             :  * shared_preload_libraries have been loaded, process wal_consistency_checking
    4748             :  * again.
    4749             :  */
    4750             : void
    4751        1526 : InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(void)
    4752             : {
    4753             :     Assert(process_shared_preload_libraries_done);
    4754             : 
    4755        1526 :     if (check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred)
    4756             :     {
    4757             :         struct config_generic *guc;
    4758             : 
    4759           0 :         guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
    4760             : 
    4761           0 :         check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false;
    4762             : 
    4763           0 :         set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
    4764             :                               wal_consistency_checking_string,
    4765             :                               guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
    4766             :                               GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
    4767             : 
    4768             :         /* checking should not be deferred again */
    4769             :         Assert(!check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred);
    4770             :     }
    4771        1526 : }
    4772             : 
    4773             : /*
    4774             :  * GUC show_hook for archive_command
    4775             :  */
    4776             : const char *
    4777        3888 : show_archive_command(void)
    4778             : {
    4779        3888 :     if (XLogArchivingActive())
    4780           0 :         return XLogArchiveCommand;
    4781             :     else
    4782        3888 :         return "(disabled)";
    4783             : }
    4784             : 
    4785             : /*
    4786             :  * GUC show_hook for in_hot_standby
    4787             :  */
    4788             : const char *
    4789       25432 : show_in_hot_standby(void)
    4790             : {
    4791             :     /*
    4792             :      * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
    4793             :      * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query.  The underlying
    4794             :      * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
    4795             :      * to the client.
    4796             :      */
    4797       25432 :     return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
    4798             : }
    4799             : 
    4800             : /*
    4801             :  * Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
    4802             :  *
    4803             :  * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
    4804             :  * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists.  As there's no
    4805             :  * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
    4806             :  * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
    4807             :  * will then copy it to shared memory later.
    4808             :  *
    4809             :  * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
    4810             :  * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
    4811             :  */
    4812             : void
    4813        1540 : LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
    4814             : {
    4815             :     Assert(reset || ControlFile == NULL);
    4816        1540 :     ControlFile = palloc(sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4817        1540 :     ReadControlFile();
    4818        1540 : }
    4819             : 
    4820             : /*
    4821             :  * Get the wal_level from the control file. For a standby, this value should be
    4822             :  * considered as its active wal_level, because it may be different from what
    4823             :  * was originally configured on standby.
    4824             :  */
    4825             : WalLevel
    4826         132 : GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby(void)
    4827             : {
    4828         132 :     return ControlFile->wal_level;
    4829             : }
    4830             : 
    4831             : /*
    4832             :  * Initialization of shared memory for XLOG
    4833             :  */
    4834             : Size
    4835        5066 : XLOGShmemSize(void)
    4836             : {
    4837             :     Size        size;
    4838             : 
    4839             :     /*
    4840             :      * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
    4841             :      * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
    4842             :      * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
    4843             :      * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
    4844             :      *
    4845             :      * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
    4846             :      * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
    4847             :      * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
    4848             :      * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
    4849             :      */
    4850        5066 :     if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
    4851             :     {
    4852             :         char        buf[32];
    4853             : 
    4854        1766 :         snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
    4855        1766 :         SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
    4856             :                         PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT);
    4857        1766 :         if (XLOGbuffers == -1)  /* failed to apply it? */
    4858           0 :             SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
    4859             :                             PGC_S_OVERRIDE);
    4860             :     }
    4861             :     Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
    4862             : 
    4863             :     /* XLogCtl */
    4864        5066 :     size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
    4865             : 
    4866             :     /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
    4867        5066 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
    4868             :     /* xlblocks array */
    4869        5066 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
    4870             :     /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
    4871        5066 :     size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
    4872             :     /* and the buffers themselves */
    4873        5066 :     size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
    4874             : 
    4875             :     /*
    4876             :      * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
    4877             :      * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores.  This lets us use this
    4878             :      * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
    4879             :      */
    4880             : 
    4881        5066 :     return size;
    4882             : }
    4883             : 
    4884             : void
    4885        1768 : XLOGShmemInit(void)
    4886             : {
    4887             :     bool        foundCFile,
    4888             :                 foundXLog;
    4889             :     char       *allocptr;
    4890             :     int         i;
    4891             :     ControlFileData *localControlFile;
    4892             : 
    4893             : #ifdef WAL_DEBUG
    4894             : 
    4895             :     /*
    4896             :      * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
    4897             :      * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
    4898             :      * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
    4899             :      */
    4900             :     if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
    4901             :     {
    4902             :         walDebugCxt = AllocSetContextCreate(TopMemoryContext,
    4903             :                                             "WAL Debug",
    4904             :                                             ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES);
    4905             :         MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(walDebugCxt, true);
    4906             :     }
    4907             : #endif
    4908             : 
    4909             : 
    4910        1768 :     XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
    4911        1768 :         ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
    4912             : 
    4913        1768 :     localControlFile = ControlFile;
    4914        1768 :     ControlFile = (ControlFileData *)
    4915        1768 :         ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
    4916             : 
    4917        1768 :     if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
    4918             :     {
    4919             :         /* both should be present or neither */
    4920             :         Assert(foundCFile && foundXLog);
    4921             : 
    4922             :         /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
    4923           0 :         WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks;
    4924             : 
    4925           0 :         if (localControlFile)
    4926           0 :             pfree(localControlFile);
    4927           0 :         return;
    4928             :     }
    4929        1768 :     memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
    4930             : 
    4931             :     /*
    4932             :      * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
    4933             :      * contents into shared memory.
    4934             :      */
    4935        1768 :     if (localControlFile)
    4936             :     {
    4937        1528 :         memcpy(ControlFile, localControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
    4938        1528 :         pfree(localControlFile);
    4939             :     }
    4940             : 
    4941             :     /*
    4942             :      * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
    4943             :      * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
    4944             :      * needed here.
    4945             :      */
    4946        1768 :     allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
    4947        1768 :     XLogCtl->xlblocks = (pg_atomic_uint64 *) allocptr;
    4948        1768 :     allocptr += sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64) * XLOGbuffers;
    4949             : 
    4950      493528 :     for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
    4951             :     {
    4952      491760 :         pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[i], InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    4953             :     }
    4954             : 
    4955             :     /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
    4956        1768 :     allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
    4957        1768 :         ((uintptr_t) allocptr) % sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded);
    4958        1768 :     WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks =
    4959             :         (WALInsertLockPadded *) allocptr;
    4960        1768 :     allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) * NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
    4961             : 
    4962       15912 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    4963             :     {
    4964       14144 :         LWLockInitialize(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LWTRANCHE_WAL_INSERT);
    4965       14144 :         pg_atomic_init_u64(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    4966       14144 :         WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    4967             :     }
    4968             : 
    4969             :     /*
    4970             :      * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
    4971             :      * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
    4972             :      * required for O_DIRECT.
    4973             :      */
    4974        1768 :     allocptr = (char *) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, allocptr);
    4975        1768 :     XLogCtl->pages = allocptr;
    4976        1768 :     memset(XLogCtl->pages, 0, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ * XLOGbuffers);
    4977             : 
    4978             :     /*
    4979             :      * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
    4980             :      * in additional info.)
    4981             :      */
    4982        1768 :     XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck = XLOGbuffers - 1;
    4983        1768 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
    4984        1768 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = false;
    4985        1768 :     XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
    4986             : 
    4987        1768 :     SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->Insert.insertpos_lck);
    4988        1768 :     SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    4989        1768 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    4990        1768 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    4991        1768 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    4992        1768 :     pg_atomic_init_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN, InvalidXLogRecPtr);
    4993             : }
    4994             : 
    4995             : /*
    4996             :  * This func must be called ONCE on system install.  It creates pg_control
    4997             :  * and the initial XLOG segment.
    4998             :  */
    4999             : void
    5000          80 : BootStrapXLOG(void)
    5001             : {
    5002             :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    5003             :     char       *buffer;
    5004             :     XLogPageHeader page;
    5005             :     XLogLongPageHeader longpage;
    5006             :     XLogRecord *record;
    5007             :     char       *recptr;
    5008             :     uint64      sysidentifier;
    5009             :     struct timeval tv;
    5010             :     pg_crc32c   crc;
    5011             : 
    5012             :     /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
    5013          80 :     SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    5014             : 
    5015             :     /*
    5016             :      * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
    5017             :      * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
    5018             :      * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get.  (Think not to
    5019             :      * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
    5020             :      * to seed it other than the system clock value...)  The upper half of the
    5021             :      * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
    5022             :      * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
    5023             :      * PID for a little extra uniqueness.  A person knowing this encoding can
    5024             :      * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
    5025             :      * perhaps be useful sometimes.
    5026             :      */
    5027          80 :     gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
    5028          80 :     sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
    5029          80 :     sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
    5030          80 :     sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
    5031             : 
    5032             :     /* page buffer must be aligned suitably for O_DIRECT */
    5033          80 :     buffer = (char *) palloc(XLOG_BLCKSZ + XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    5034          80 :     page = (XLogPageHeader) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, buffer);
    5035          80 :     memset(page, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    5036             : 
    5037             :     /*
    5038             :      * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
    5039             :      *
    5040             :      * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
    5041             :      * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
    5042             :      * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
    5043             :      */
    5044          80 :     checkPoint.redo = wal_segment_size + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    5045          80 :     checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5046          80 :     checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5047          80 :     checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
    5048             :     checkPoint.nextXid =
    5049          80 :         FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(0, FirstNormalTransactionId);
    5050          80 :     checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
    5051          80 :     checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
    5052          80 :     checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 0;
    5053          80 :     checkPoint.oldestXid = FirstNormalTransactionId;
    5054          80 :     checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
    5055          80 :     checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
    5056          80 :     checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
    5057          80 :     checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5058          80 :     checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5059          80 :     checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    5060          80 :     checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5061             : 
    5062          80 :     TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    5063          80 :     TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    5064          80 :     TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    5065          80 :     MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    5066          80 :     AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
    5067          80 :     SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    5068          80 :     SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB, true);
    5069          80 :     SetCommitTsLimit(InvalidTransactionId, InvalidTransactionId);
    5070             : 
    5071             :     /* Set up the XLOG page header */
    5072          80 :     page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
    5073          80 :     page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
    5074          80 :     page->xlp_tli = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5075          80 :     page->xlp_pageaddr = wal_segment_size;
    5076          80 :     longpage = (XLogLongPageHeader) page;
    5077          80 :     longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
    5078          80 :     longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
    5079          80 :     longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    5080             : 
    5081             :     /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
    5082          80 :     recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
    5083          80 :     record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
    5084          80 :     record->xl_prev = 0;
    5085          80 :     record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
    5086          80 :     record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
    5087          80 :     record->xl_info = XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN;
    5088          80 :     record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
    5089          80 :     recptr += SizeOfXLogRecord;
    5090             :     /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
    5091          80 :     *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
    5092          80 :     *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
    5093          80 :     memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
    5094          80 :     recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
    5095             :     Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
    5096             : 
    5097          80 :     INIT_CRC32C(crc);
    5098          80 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
    5099          80 :     COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
    5100          80 :     FIN_CRC32C(crc);
    5101          80 :     record->xl_crc = crc;
    5102             : 
    5103             :     /* Create first XLOG segment file */
    5104          80 :     openLogTLI = BootstrapTimeLineID;
    5105          80 :     openLogFile = XLogFileInit(1, BootstrapTimeLineID);
    5106             : 
    5107             :     /*
    5108             :      * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
    5109             :      * close the file again in a moment.
    5110             :      */
    5111             : 
    5112             :     /* Write the first page with the initial record */
    5113          80 :     errno = 0;
    5114          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_WRITE);
    5115          80 :     if (write(openLogFile, page, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
    5116             :     {
    5117             :         /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
    5118           0 :         if (errno == 0)
    5119           0 :             errno = ENOSPC;
    5120           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5121             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5122             :                  errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5123             :     }
    5124          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    5125             : 
    5126          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_SYNC);
    5127          80 :     if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
    5128           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5129             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5130             :                  errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5131          80 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    5132             : 
    5133          80 :     if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
    5134           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    5135             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5136             :                  errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
    5137             : 
    5138          80 :     openLogFile = -1;
    5139             : 
    5140             :     /* Now create pg_control */
    5141          80 :     InitControlFile(sysidentifier);
    5142          80 :     ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
    5143          80 :     ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
    5144          80 :     ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
    5145             : 
    5146             :     /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
    5147          80 :     WriteControlFile();
    5148             : 
    5149             :     /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
    5150          80 :     BootStrapCLOG();
    5151          80 :     BootStrapCommitTs();
    5152          80 :     BootStrapSUBTRANS();
    5153          80 :     BootStrapMultiXact();
    5154             : 
    5155          80 :     pfree(buffer);
    5156             : 
    5157             :     /*
    5158             :      * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
    5159             :      * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
    5160             :      */
    5161          80 :     ReadControlFile();
    5162          80 : }
    5163             : 
    5164             : static char *
    5165        1360 : str_time(pg_time_t tnow)
    5166             : {
    5167             :     static char buf[128];
    5168             : 
    5169        1360 :     pg_strftime(buf, sizeof(buf),
    5170             :                 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
    5171        1360 :                 pg_localtime(&tnow, log_timezone));
    5172             : 
    5173        1360 :     return buf;
    5174             : }
    5175             : 
    5176             : /*
    5177             :  * Initialize the first WAL segment on new timeline.
    5178             :  */
    5179             : static void
    5180          90 : XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
    5181             : {
    5182             :     char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5183             :     XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    5184             :     XLogSegNo   startLogSegNo;
    5185             : 
    5186             :     /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
    5187             :     Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
    5188             : 
    5189             :     /*
    5190             :      * Update min recovery point one last time.
    5191             :      */
    5192          90 :     UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
    5193             : 
    5194             :     /*
    5195             :      * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
    5196             :      * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
    5197             :      * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
    5198             :      * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
    5199             :      */
    5200          90 :     XLByteToPrevSeg(endOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5201          90 :     XLByteToSeg(endOfLog, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5202             : 
    5203             :     /*
    5204             :      * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
    5205             :      * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
    5206             :      * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
    5207             :      * on the new timeline.
    5208             :      */
    5209          90 :     if (endLogSegNo == startLogSegNo)
    5210             :     {
    5211             :         /*
    5212             :          * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
    5213             :          *
    5214             :          * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
    5215             :          * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
    5216             :          * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
    5217             :          */
    5218          74 :         XLogFileCopy(newTLI, endLogSegNo, endTLI, endLogSegNo,
    5219          74 :                      XLogSegmentOffset(endOfLog, wal_segment_size));
    5220             :     }
    5221             :     else
    5222             :     {
    5223             :         /*
    5224             :          * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
    5225             :          * segment on the new timeline.
    5226             :          */
    5227             :         int         fd;
    5228             : 
    5229          16 :         fd = XLogFileInit(startLogSegNo, newTLI);
    5230             : 
    5231          16 :         if (close(fd) != 0)
    5232             :         {
    5233           0 :             int         save_errno = errno;
    5234             : 
    5235           0 :             XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5236           0 :             errno = save_errno;
    5237           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    5238             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    5239             :                      errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    5240             :         }
    5241             :     }
    5242             : 
    5243             :     /*
    5244             :      * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
    5245             :      * for the new segment.
    5246             :      */
    5247          90 :     XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5248          90 :     XLogArchiveCleanup(xlogfname);
    5249          90 : }
    5250             : 
    5251             : /*
    5252             :  * Perform cleanup actions at the conclusion of archive recovery.
    5253             :  */
    5254             : static void
    5255          90 : CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog,
    5256             :                             TimeLineID newTLI)
    5257             : {
    5258             :     /*
    5259             :      * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
    5260             :      */
    5261          90 :     if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0)
    5262           4 :         ExecuteRecoveryCommand(recoveryEndCommand,
    5263             :                                "recovery_end_command",
    5264             :                                true,
    5265             :                                WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_END_COMMAND);
    5266             : 
    5267             :     /*
    5268             :      * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
    5269             :      *
    5270             :      * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
    5271             :      * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
    5272             :      * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
    5273             :      * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
    5274             :      */
    5275          90 :     RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
    5276             : 
    5277             :     /*
    5278             :      * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
    5279             :      * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
    5280             :      * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
    5281             :      * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
    5282             :      * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
    5283             :      * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
    5284             :      * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
    5285             :      * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
    5286             :      * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
    5287             :      * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
    5288             :      * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
    5289             :      * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
    5290             :      * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
    5291             :      * caused such problems).
    5292             :      *
    5293             :      * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
    5294             :      * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
    5295             :      * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
    5296             :      * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
    5297             :      * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
    5298             :      *
    5299             :      * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
    5300             :      * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
    5301             :      * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
    5302             :      * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
    5303             :      */
    5304          90 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(EndOfLog, wal_segment_size) != 0 &&
    5305             :         XLogArchivingActive())
    5306             :     {
    5307             :         char        origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5308             :         XLogSegNo   endLogSegNo;
    5309             : 
    5310          14 :         XLByteToPrevSeg(EndOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5311          14 :         XLogFileName(origfname, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5312             : 
    5313          14 :         if (!XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(origfname))
    5314             :         {
    5315             :             char        origpath[MAXPGPATH];
    5316             :             char        partialfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    5317             :             char        partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
    5318             : 
    5319           8 :             XLogFilePath(origpath, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    5320           8 :             snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
    5321           8 :             snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
    5322             : 
    5323             :             /*
    5324             :              * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
    5325             :              * file.
    5326             :              */
    5327           8 :             XLogArchiveCleanup(partialfname);
    5328             : 
    5329           8 :             durable_rename(origpath, partialpath, ERROR);
    5330           8 :             XLogArchiveNotify(partialfname);
    5331             :         }
    5332             :     }
    5333          90 : }
    5334             : 
    5335             : /*
    5336             :  * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
    5337             :  * for various aspects of recovery operation.
    5338             :  *
    5339             :  * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
    5340             :  * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
    5341             :  * If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
    5342             :  */
    5343             : static void
    5344         452 : CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
    5345             : {
    5346             :     /*
    5347             :      * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
    5348             :      * wal_level.
    5349             :      */
    5350         452 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && ControlFile->wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL)
    5351             :     {
    5352           4 :         ereport(FATAL,
    5353             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    5354             :                  errmsg("WAL was generated with wal_level=minimal, cannot continue recovering"),
    5355             :                  errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set wal_level=minimal on the server."),
    5356             :                  errhint("Use a backup taken after setting wal_level to higher than minimal.")));
    5357             :     }
    5358             : 
    5359             :     /*
    5360             :      * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
    5361             :      * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
    5362             :      */
    5363         448 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
    5364             :     {
    5365             :         /* We ignore autovacuum_max_workers when we make this test. */
    5366         214 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
    5367             :                                      MaxConnections,
    5368         214 :                                      ControlFile->MaxConnections);
    5369         214 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
    5370             :                                      max_worker_processes,
    5371         214 :                                      ControlFile->max_worker_processes);
    5372         214 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
    5373             :                                      max_wal_senders,
    5374         214 :                                      ControlFile->max_wal_senders);
    5375         214 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
    5376             :                                      max_prepared_xacts,
    5377         214 :                                      ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts);
    5378         214 :         RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
    5379             :                                      max_locks_per_xact,
    5380         214 :                                      ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact);
    5381             :     }
    5382         448 : }
    5383             : 
    5384             : /*
    5385             :  * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
    5386             :  */
    5387             : void
    5388        1520 : StartupXLOG(void)
    5389             : {
    5390             :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert;
    5391             :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    5392             :     bool        wasShutdown;
    5393             :     bool        didCrash;
    5394             :     bool        haveTblspcMap;
    5395             :     bool        haveBackupLabel;
    5396             :     XLogRecPtr  EndOfLog;
    5397             :     TimeLineID  EndOfLogTLI;
    5398             :     TimeLineID  newTLI;
    5399             :     bool        performedWalRecovery;
    5400             :     EndOfWalRecoveryInfo *endOfRecoveryInfo;
    5401             :     XLogRecPtr  abortedRecPtr;
    5402             :     XLogRecPtr  missingContrecPtr;
    5403             :     TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
    5404        1520 :     bool        promoted = false;
    5405             : 
    5406             :     /*
    5407             :      * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
    5408             :      * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
    5409             :      */
    5410             :     Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
    5411             :     Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
    5412             :            CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
    5413        1520 :     CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
    5414             : 
    5415             :     /*
    5416             :      * Check that contents look valid.
    5417             :      */
    5418        1520 :     if (!XRecOffIsValid(ControlFile->checkPoint))
    5419           0 :         ereport(FATAL,
    5420             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    5421             :                  errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
    5422             : 
    5423        1520 :     switch (ControlFile->state)
    5424             :     {
    5425        1142 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
    5426             : 
    5427             :             /*
    5428             :              * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
    5429             :              * mode
    5430             :              */
    5431        1142 :             ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
    5432             :                     (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
    5433             :                             str_time(ControlFile->time))));
    5434        1142 :             break;
    5435             : 
    5436          52 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY:
    5437          52 :             ereport(LOG,
    5438             :                     (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
    5439             :                             str_time(ControlFile->time))));
    5440          52 :             break;
    5441             : 
    5442           0 :         case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
    5443           0 :             ereport(LOG,
    5444             :                     (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
    5445             :                             str_time(ControlFile->time))));
    5446           0 :             break;
    5447             : 
    5448           0 :         case DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY:
    5449           0 :             ereport(LOG,
    5450             :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
    5451             :                             str_time(ControlFile->time)),
    5452             :                      errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
    5453             :                              " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
    5454           0 :             break;
    5455             : 
    5456          12 :         case DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY:
    5457          12 :             ereport(LOG,
    5458             :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
    5459             :                             str_time(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.time)),
    5460             :                      errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
    5461             :                              " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
    5462          12 :             break;
    5463             : 
    5464         314 :         case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
    5465         314 :             ereport(LOG,
    5466             :                     (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
    5467             :                             str_time(ControlFile->time))));
    5468         314 :             break;
    5469             : 
    5470           0 :         default:
    5471           0 :             ereport(FATAL,
    5472             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED),
    5473             :                      errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
    5474             :     }
    5475             : 
    5476             :     /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
    5477             : #ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
    5478             :     if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED)
    5479             :         pg_usleep(60000000L);
    5480             : #endif
    5481             : 
    5482             :     /*
    5483             :      * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
    5484             :      * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
    5485             :      * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
    5486             :      */
    5487        1520 :     ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure();
    5488             : 
    5489             :     /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
    5490        1520 :     if (!IsBootstrapProcessingMode())
    5491        1440 :         RegisterTimeout(STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT,
    5492             :                         startup_progress_timeout_handler);
    5493             : 
    5494             :     /*----------
    5495             :      * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
    5496             :      *
    5497             :      * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
    5498             :      *   used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
    5499             :      *   bloat this path.  This is done first as there is no point to sync
    5500             :      *   this temporary data.
    5501             :      *
    5502             :      * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
    5503             :      *   which we had not actually fsync'd yet.  Therefore, a power failure in
    5504             :      *   the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
    5505             :      *   though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
    5506             :      *   persisted.  To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
    5507             :      */
    5508        1520 :     if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED &&
    5509         378 :         ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY)
    5510             :     {
    5511         326 :         RemoveTempXlogFiles();
    5512         326 :         SyncDataDirectory();
    5513         326 :         didCrash = true;
    5514             :     }
    5515             :     else
    5516        1194 :         didCrash = false;
    5517             : 
    5518             :     /*
    5519             :      * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
    5520             :      *
    5521             :      * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
    5522             :      * any.  It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
    5523             :      * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
    5524             :      * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
    5525             :      */
    5526        1520 :     InitWalRecovery(ControlFile, &wasShutdown,
    5527             :                     &haveBackupLabel, &haveTblspcMap);
    5528        1520 :     checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
    5529             : 
    5530             :     /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
    5531        1520 :     TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    5532        1520 :     TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    5533        1520 :     TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    5534        1520 :     MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    5535        1520 :     AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
    5536        1520 :     SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    5537        1520 :     SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB, true);
    5538        1520 :     SetCommitTsLimit(checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid,
    5539             :                      checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
    5540        1520 :     XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    5541             : 
    5542             :     /*
    5543             :      * Clear out any old relcache cache files.  This is *necessary* if we do
    5544             :      * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
    5545             :      * being out of sync with database reality.  In theory we could leave them
    5546             :      * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
    5547             :      * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
    5548             :      * first backend startup.  These files needs to be removed from all
    5549             :      * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
    5550             :      * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
    5551             :      * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
    5552             :      * symlinks.
    5553             :      */
    5554        1520 :     RelationCacheInitFileRemove();
    5555             : 
    5556             :     /*
    5557             :      * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
    5558             :      * required resources.
    5559             :      */
    5560        1520 :     StartupReplicationSlots();
    5561             : 
    5562             :     /*
    5563             :      * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
    5564             :      * during crash recovery.
    5565             :      */
    5566        1520 :     StartupReorderBuffer();
    5567             : 
    5568             :     /*
    5569             :      * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
    5570             :      * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
    5571             :      */
    5572        1520 :     StartupCLOG();
    5573             : 
    5574             :     /*
    5575             :      * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
    5576             :      * truncations.
    5577             :      */
    5578        1520 :     StartupMultiXact();
    5579             : 
    5580             :     /*
    5581             :      * Ditto for commit timestamps.  Activate the facility if the setting is
    5582             :      * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
    5583             :      * timestamps done when the setting was disabled.  This facility can be
    5584             :      * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
    5585             :      */
    5586        1520 :     if (ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
    5587          16 :         StartupCommitTs();
    5588             : 
    5589             :     /*
    5590             :      * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
    5591             :      */
    5592        1520 :     StartupReplicationOrigin();
    5593             : 
    5594             :     /*
    5595             :      * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
    5596             :      * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
    5597             :      * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
    5598             :      */
    5599        1520 :     if (ControlFile->state == DB_SHUTDOWNED)
    5600        1128 :         pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN,
    5601        1128 :                                        ControlFile->unloggedLSN);
    5602             :     else
    5603         392 :         pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN,
    5604             :                                        FirstNormalUnloggedLSN);
    5605             : 
    5606             :     /*
    5607             :      * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
    5608             :      * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
    5609             :      * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
    5610             :      * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
    5611             :      * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
    5612             :      * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
    5613             :      * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
    5614             :      * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
    5615             :      * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
    5616             :      * and regret later.
    5617             :      */
    5618        1520 :     restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, recoveryTargetTLI);
    5619             : 
    5620             :     /*
    5621             :      * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
    5622             :      * be able to work on entries generated by redo.  Doing a scan before
    5623             :      * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
    5624             :      * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
    5625             :      * replay.  This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
    5626             :      * of the on-disk two-phase data.
    5627             :      */
    5628        1520 :     restoreTwoPhaseData();
    5629             : 
    5630             :     /*
    5631             :      * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
    5632             :      * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
    5633             :      * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
    5634             :      *
    5635             :      * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
    5636             :      * already been restored from disk.
    5637             :      *
    5638             :      * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
    5639             :      * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
    5640             :      */
    5641        1520 :     if (didCrash)
    5642         326 :         pgstat_discard_stats();
    5643             :     else
    5644        1194 :         pgstat_restore_stats();
    5645             : 
    5646        1520 :     lastFullPageWrites = checkPoint.fullPageWrites;
    5647             : 
    5648        1520 :     RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    5649        1520 :     doPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
    5650             : 
    5651             :     /* REDO */
    5652        1520 :     if (InRecovery)
    5653             :     {
    5654             :         /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
    5655         392 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5656         392 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    5657         196 :             XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
    5658             :         else
    5659         196 :             XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH;
    5660         392 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    5661             : 
    5662             :         /*
    5663             :          * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
    5664             :          * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
    5665             :          * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
    5666             :          * backup history file.
    5667             :          *
    5668             :          * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
    5669             :          */
    5670         392 :         UpdateControlFile();
    5671             : 
    5672             :         /*
    5673             :          * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
    5674             :          * has now been propagated into pg_control.  We must get rid of the
    5675             :          * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
    5676             :          * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
    5677             :          * to the backup start point.  It seems prudent though to just rename
    5678             :          * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
    5679             :          */
    5680         392 :         if (haveBackupLabel)
    5681             :         {
    5682         126 :             unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD);
    5683         126 :             durable_rename(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, FATAL);
    5684             :         }
    5685             : 
    5686             :         /*
    5687             :          * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
    5688             :          * symlinks have been created.  We must get rid of the map file so
    5689             :          * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
    5690             :          * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
    5691             :          * rather than delete it completely.
    5692             :          */
    5693         392 :         if (haveTblspcMap)
    5694             :         {
    5695           2 :             unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD);
    5696           2 :             durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, FATAL);
    5697             :         }
    5698             : 
    5699             :         /*
    5700             :          * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint.  When doing crash
    5701             :          * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL.  Particularly, in
    5702             :          * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
    5703             :          * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint.  However,
    5704             :          * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
    5705             :          * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
    5706             :          * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
    5707             :          * references when checking for data consistency.
    5708             :          */
    5709         392 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    5710             :         {
    5711         196 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    5712         196 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    5713             :         }
    5714             :         else
    5715             :         {
    5716         196 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    5717         196 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
    5718             :         }
    5719             : 
    5720             :         /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
    5721         392 :         CheckRequiredParameterValues();
    5722             : 
    5723             :         /*
    5724             :          * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
    5725             :          * reset.  This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
    5726             :          * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
    5727             :          * garbage is left over from before.
    5728             :          */
    5729         392 :         ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP);
    5730             : 
    5731             :         /*
    5732             :          * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
    5733             :          * behind by crashed backends.
    5734             :          */
    5735         392 :         DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles();
    5736             : 
    5737             :         /*
    5738             :          * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
    5739             :          * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
    5740             :          * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
    5741             :          * running-xacts WAL record.
    5742             :          */
    5743         392 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby)
    5744             :         {
    5745             :             TransactionId *xids;
    5746             :             int         nxids;
    5747             : 
    5748         186 :             ereport(DEBUG1,
    5749             :                     (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
    5750             : 
    5751         186 :             InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
    5752             : 
    5753         186 :             if (wasShutdown)
    5754          44 :                 oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
    5755             :             else
    5756         142 :                 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
    5757             :             Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(oldestActiveXID));
    5758             : 
    5759             :             /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
    5760         186 :             ProcArrayInitRecovery(XidFromFullTransactionId(TransamVariables->nextXid));
    5761             : 
    5762             :             /*
    5763             :              * Startup subtrans only.  CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
    5764             :              * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
    5765             :              * during recovery and need not be started yet.
    5766             :              */
    5767         186 :             StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
    5768             : 
    5769             :             /*
    5770             :              * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
    5771             :              * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
    5772             :              * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
    5773             :              * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
    5774             :              */
    5775         186 :             if (wasShutdown)
    5776             :             {
    5777             :                 RunningTransactionsData running;
    5778             :                 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
    5779             : 
    5780             :                 /*
    5781             :                  * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
    5782             :                  * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
    5783             :                  * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
    5784             :                  * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
    5785             :                  */
    5786          44 :                 running.xcnt = nxids;
    5787          44 :                 running.subxcnt = 0;
    5788          44 :                 running.subxid_overflow = false;
    5789          44 :                 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    5790          44 :                 running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
    5791          44 :                 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    5792          44 :                 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
    5793             :                 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
    5794          44 :                 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
    5795          44 :                 running.xids = xids;
    5796             : 
    5797          44 :                 ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
    5798             : 
    5799          44 :                 StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
    5800             :             }
    5801             :         }
    5802             : 
    5803             :         /*
    5804             :          * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
    5805             :          */
    5806         392 :         PerformWalRecovery();
    5807         292 :         performedWalRecovery = true;
    5808             :     }
    5809             :     else
    5810        1128 :         performedWalRecovery = false;
    5811             : 
    5812             :     /*
    5813             :      * Finish WAL recovery.
    5814             :      */
    5815        1420 :     endOfRecoveryInfo = FinishWalRecovery();
    5816        1420 :     EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
    5817        1420 :     EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
    5818        1420 :     abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
    5819        1420 :     missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
    5820             : 
    5821             :     /*
    5822             :      * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
    5823             :      * up.
    5824             :      */
    5825        1420 :     set_ps_display("");
    5826             : 
    5827             :     /*
    5828             :      * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
    5829             :      * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
    5830             :      * the point where the database is consistent.  For regular online
    5831             :      * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
    5832             :      * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
    5833             :      * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
    5834             :      * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
    5835             :      * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica).  For
    5836             :      * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
    5837             :      * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
    5838             :      * to false.
    5839             :      *
    5840             :      * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
    5841             :      * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
    5842             :      * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
    5843             :      * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
    5844             :      */
    5845        1420 :     if (InRecovery &&
    5846         292 :         (EndOfLog < LocalMinRecoveryPoint ||
    5847         292 :          !XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint)))
    5848             :     {
    5849             :         /*
    5850             :          * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
    5851             :          * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
    5852             :          * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
    5853             :          * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
    5854             :          */
    5855           0 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested || ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
    5856             :         {
    5857           0 :             if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) || ControlFile->backupEndRequired)
    5858           0 :                 ereport(FATAL,
    5859             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    5860             :                          errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
    5861             :                          errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
    5862             :             else
    5863           0 :                 ereport(FATAL,
    5864             :                         (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    5865             :                          errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
    5866             :         }
    5867             :     }
    5868             : 
    5869             :     /*
    5870             :      * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
    5871             :      * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
    5872             :      * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
    5873             :      * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
    5874             :      * end-of-recovery steps fail.
    5875             :      */
    5876        1420 :     if (InRecovery)
    5877         292 :         ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT);
    5878             : 
    5879             :     /*
    5880             :      * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
    5881             :      * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
    5882             :      * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
    5883             :      */
    5884        1420 :     oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(NULL, NULL);
    5885             : 
    5886             :     /*
    5887             :      * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
    5888             :      * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
    5889             :      */
    5890        1420 :     SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive();
    5891             : 
    5892             :     /*
    5893             :      * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
    5894             :      *
    5895             :      * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID.  This handles a
    5896             :      * couple of issues.  If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
    5897             :      * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
    5898             :      * it a unique new ID.  Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
    5899             :      * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
    5900             :      * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
    5901             :      * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that.  We can dodge the
    5902             :      * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
    5903             :      *
    5904             :      * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
    5905             :      */
    5906        1420 :     newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
    5907        1420 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
    5908             :     {
    5909          90 :         newTLI = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI) + 1;
    5910          90 :         ereport(LOG,
    5911             :                 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
    5912             : 
    5913             :         /*
    5914             :          * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment.  (Note that we also
    5915             :          * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
    5916             :          * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
    5917             :          */
    5918          90 :         XLogInitNewTimeline(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
    5919             : 
    5920             :         /*
    5921             :          * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
    5922             :          * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
    5923             :          */
    5924          90 :         if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
    5925          84 :             durable_unlink(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
    5926             : 
    5927          90 :         if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
    5928           6 :             durable_unlink(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL);
    5929             : 
    5930             :         /*
    5931             :          * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
    5932             :          * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
    5933             :          * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
    5934             :          * servers.  If we crash before actually switching to the new
    5935             :          * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
    5936             :          * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
    5937             :          * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
    5938             :          * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
    5939             :          */
    5940          90 :         writeTimeLineHistory(newTLI, recoveryTargetTLI,
    5941             :                              EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
    5942             : 
    5943          90 :         ereport(LOG,
    5944             :                 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
    5945             :     }
    5946             : 
    5947             :     /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
    5948        1420 :     XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID = newTLI;
    5949        1420 :     XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
    5950             : 
    5951             :     /*
    5952             :      * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
    5953             :      * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
    5954             :      * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
    5955             :      * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
    5956             :      */
    5957        1420 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(missingContrecPtr))
    5958             :     {
    5959             :         /*
    5960             :          * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
    5961             :          * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
    5962             :          * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
    5963             :          * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
    5964             :          * disregard.
    5965             :          */
    5966             :         Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
    5967             :         Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(abortedRecPtr));
    5968          20 :         EndOfLog = missingContrecPtr;
    5969             :     }
    5970             : 
    5971             :     /*
    5972             :      * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
    5973             :      * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
    5974             :      * previous incarnation.
    5975             :      */
    5976        1420 :     Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    5977        1420 :     Insert->PrevBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRec);
    5978        1420 :     Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
    5979             : 
    5980             :     /*
    5981             :      * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
    5982             :      * record spans, not the one it starts in.  The last block is indeed the
    5983             :      * one we want to use.
    5984             :      */
    5985        1420 :     if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
    5986             :     {
    5987             :         char       *page;
    5988             :         int         len;
    5989             :         int         firstIdx;
    5990             : 
    5991        1372 :         firstIdx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(EndOfLog);
    5992        1372 :         len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
    5993             :         Assert(len < XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    5994             : 
    5995             :         /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
    5996        1372 :         page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
    5997        1372 :         memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
    5998        1372 :         memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
    5999             : 
    6000        1372 :         pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[firstIdx], endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ);
    6001        1372 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
    6002             :     }
    6003             :     else
    6004             :     {
    6005             :         /*
    6006             :          * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
    6007             :          * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
    6008             :          * buffer.
    6009             :          */
    6010          48 :         XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = EndOfLog;
    6011             :     }
    6012             : 
    6013             :     /*
    6014             :      * Update local and shared status.  This is OK to do without any locks
    6015             :      * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
    6016             :      */
    6017        1420 :     LogwrtResult.Write = LogwrtResult.Flush = EndOfLog;
    6018        1420 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logInsertResult, EndOfLog);
    6019        1420 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult, EndOfLog);
    6020        1420 :     pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult, EndOfLog);
    6021        1420 :     XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndOfLog;
    6022        1420 :     XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = EndOfLog;
    6023             : 
    6024             :     /*
    6025             :      * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
    6026             :      */
    6027        1420 :     PreallocXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6028             : 
    6029             :     /*
    6030             :      * Okay, we're officially UP.
    6031             :      */
    6032        1420 :     InRecovery = false;
    6033             : 
    6034             :     /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
    6035        1420 :     XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    6036        1420 :     XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = EndOfLog;
    6037             : 
    6038             :     /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
    6039        1420 :     LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6040        1420 :     TransamVariables->latestCompletedXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
    6041        1420 :     FullTransactionIdRetreat(&TransamVariables->latestCompletedXid);
    6042        1420 :     LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock);
    6043             : 
    6044             :     /*
    6045             :      * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby.  (commit
    6046             :      * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
    6047             :      */
    6048        1420 :     if (standbyState == STANDBY_DISABLED)
    6049        1330 :         StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
    6050             : 
    6051             :     /*
    6052             :      * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
    6053             :      */
    6054        1420 :     TrimCLOG();
    6055        1420 :     TrimMultiXact();
    6056             : 
    6057             :     /*
    6058             :      * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions.  This needs to
    6059             :      * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
    6060             :      * it may be possible that we have to recovery some transactions from it.
    6061             :      */
    6062        1420 :     RecoverPreparedTransactions();
    6063             : 
    6064             :     /* Shut down xlogreader */
    6065        1420 :     ShutdownWalRecovery();
    6066             : 
    6067             :     /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
    6068        1420 :     LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
    6069             : 
    6070             :     /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
    6071        1420 :     if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(abortedRecPtr))
    6072             :     {
    6073             :         Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(missingContrecPtr));
    6074          20 :         CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(abortedRecPtr, missingContrecPtr, newTLI);
    6075             :     }
    6076             : 
    6077             :     /*
    6078             :      * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
    6079             :      * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
    6080             :      * record is written.
    6081             :      */
    6082        1420 :     Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
    6083        1420 :     UpdateFullPageWrites();
    6084             : 
    6085             :     /*
    6086             :      * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
    6087             :      */
    6088        1420 :     if (performedWalRecovery)
    6089         292 :         promoted = PerformRecoveryXLogAction();
    6090             : 
    6091             :     /*
    6092             :      * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
    6093             :      * backends to write WAL.
    6094             :      */
    6095        1420 :     XLogReportParameters();
    6096             : 
    6097             :     /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
    6098        1420 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested)
    6099          90 :         CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
    6100             : 
    6101             :     /*
    6102             :      * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
    6103             :      * commit timestamp.
    6104             :      */
    6105        1420 :     CompleteCommitTsInitialization();
    6106             : 
    6107             :     /*
    6108             :      * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
    6109             :      *
    6110             :      * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
    6111             :      * consequence.  SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
    6112             :      * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
    6113             :      * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
    6114             :      * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
    6115             :      * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
    6116             :      * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
    6117             :      *
    6118             :      * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
    6119             :      * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
    6120             :      * updates to shared memory.
    6121             :      */
    6122        1420 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6123        1420 :     ControlFile->state = DB_IN_PRODUCTION;
    6124             : 
    6125        1420 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6126        1420 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_DONE;
    6127        1420 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6128             : 
    6129        1420 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6130        1420 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6131             : 
    6132             :     /*
    6133             :      * Shutdown the recovery environment.  This must occur after
    6134             :      * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
    6135             :      * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
    6136             :      * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
    6137             :      * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage.  This is
    6138             :      * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
    6139             :      * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
    6140             :      */
    6141        1420 :     if (standbyState != STANDBY_DISABLED)
    6142          90 :         ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment();
    6143             : 
    6144             :     /*
    6145             :      * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
    6146             :      * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
    6147             :      */
    6148        1420 :     WalSndWakeup(true, true);
    6149             : 
    6150             :     /*
    6151             :      * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
    6152             :      * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
    6153             :      * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
    6154             :      * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
    6155             :      */
    6156        1420 :     if (promoted)
    6157          76 :         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE);
    6158        1420 : }
    6159             : 
    6160             : /*
    6161             :  * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we switch from crash
    6162             :  * recovery to archive recovery mode.  Updates the control file accordingly.
    6163             :  */
    6164             : void
    6165           4 : SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
    6166             : {
    6167             :     /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
    6168           4 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6169           4 :     ControlFile->state = DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY;
    6170           4 :     if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
    6171             :     {
    6172           4 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
    6173           4 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
    6174             :     }
    6175             :     /* update local copy */
    6176           4 :     LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    6177           4 :     LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    6178             : 
    6179             :     /*
    6180             :      * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
    6181             :      * this point.
    6182             :      */
    6183           4 :     updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
    6184             : 
    6185           4 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6186             : 
    6187             :     /*
    6188             :      * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
    6189             :      * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
    6190             :      */
    6191           4 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6192           4 :     XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE;
    6193           4 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6194             : 
    6195           4 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6196           4 : }
    6197             : 
    6198             : /*
    6199             :  * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we reach the end of backup.
    6200             :  * Updates the control file accordingly.
    6201             :  */
    6202             : void
    6203         126 : ReachedEndOfBackup(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
    6204             : {
    6205             :     /*
    6206             :      * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
    6207             :      * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
    6208             :      * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery).  Reset
    6209             :      * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
    6210             :      * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
    6211             :      * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
    6212             :      */
    6213         126 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6214             : 
    6215         126 :     if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
    6216             :     {
    6217         118 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
    6218         118 :         ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = tli;
    6219             :     }
    6220             : 
    6221         126 :     ControlFile->backupStartPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6222         126 :     ControlFile->backupEndPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6223         126 :     ControlFile->backupEndRequired = false;
    6224         126 :     UpdateControlFile();
    6225             : 
    6226         126 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6227         126 : }
    6228             : 
    6229             : /*
    6230             :  * Perform whatever XLOG actions are necessary at end of REDO.
    6231             :  *
    6232             :  * The goal here is to make sure that we'll be able to recover properly if
    6233             :  * we crash again. If we choose to write a checkpoint, we'll write a shutdown
    6234             :  * checkpoint rather than an on-line one. This is not particularly critical,
    6235             :  * but since we may be assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows
    6236             :  * us to have the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
    6237             :  * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
    6238             :  */
    6239             : static bool
    6240         292 : PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
    6241             : {
    6242         292 :     bool        promoted = false;
    6243             : 
    6244             :     /*
    6245             :      * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
    6246             :      *
    6247             :      * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
    6248             :      * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
    6249             :      * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
    6250             :      * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
    6251             :      * checking in xlog_redo.
    6252             :      *
    6253             :      * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
    6254             :      * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
    6255             :      * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
    6256             :      */
    6257         382 :     if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && IsUnderPostmaster &&
    6258          90 :         PromoteIsTriggered())
    6259             :     {
    6260          76 :         promoted = true;
    6261             : 
    6262             :         /*
    6263             :          * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
    6264             :          * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
    6265             :          * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
    6266             :          * could continue to be for minutes after this.  That sounds strange,
    6267             :          * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
    6268             :          * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
    6269             :          * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
    6270             :          */
    6271          76 :         CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord();
    6272             :     }
    6273             :     else
    6274             :     {
    6275         216 :         RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
    6276             :                           CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE |
    6277             :                           CHECKPOINT_WAIT);
    6278             :     }
    6279             : 
    6280         292 :     return promoted;
    6281             : }
    6282             : 
    6283             : /*
    6284             :  * Is the system still in recovery?
    6285             :  *
    6286             :  * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
    6287             :  * shared memory.
    6288             :  */
    6289             : bool
    6290   106193714 : RecoveryInProgress(void)
    6291             : {
    6292             :     /*
    6293             :      * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
    6294             :      * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
    6295             :      * shared variable has once been seen false.
    6296             :      */
    6297   106193714 :     if (!LocalRecoveryInProgress)
    6298   101513250 :         return false;
    6299             :     else
    6300             :     {
    6301             :         /*
    6302             :          * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
    6303             :          * shared variable.
    6304             :          */
    6305     4680464 :         volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
    6306             : 
    6307     4680464 :         LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6308             : 
    6309             :         /*
    6310             :          * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
    6311             :          * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
    6312             :          * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
    6313             :          */
    6314             : 
    6315     4680464 :         return LocalRecoveryInProgress;
    6316             :     }
    6317             : }
    6318             : 
    6319             : /*
    6320             :  * Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
    6321             :  *
    6322             :  * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
    6323             :  * file.  See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
    6324             :  */
    6325             : RecoveryState
    6326         102 : GetRecoveryState(void)
    6327             : {
    6328             :     RecoveryState retval;
    6329             : 
    6330         102 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6331         102 :     retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
    6332         102 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6333             : 
    6334         102 :     return retval;
    6335             : }
    6336             : 
    6337             : /*
    6338             :  * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
    6339             :  *
    6340             :  * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
    6341             :  * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
    6342             :  * within specific processes regardless of the global state.
    6343             :  */
    6344             : bool
    6345    53181802 : XLogInsertAllowed(void)
    6346             : {
    6347             :     /*
    6348             :      * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
    6349             :      * return it.  This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
    6350             :      * done.
    6351             :      */
    6352    53181802 :     if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
    6353    52990486 :         return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
    6354             : 
    6355             :     /*
    6356             :      * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
    6357             :      */
    6358      191316 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    6359      178470 :         return false;
    6360             : 
    6361             :     /*
    6362             :      * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
    6363             :      * no need to keep checking.
    6364             :      */
    6365       12846 :     LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
    6366       12846 :     return true;
    6367             : }
    6368             : 
    6369             : /*
    6370             :  * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
    6371             :  *
    6372             :  * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
    6373             :  * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
    6374             :  *
    6375             :  * Returns the previous value of LocalXLogInsertAllowed.
    6376             :  */
    6377             : static int
    6378        1476 : LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
    6379             : {
    6380        1476 :     int         oldXLogAllowed = LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
    6381             : 
    6382        1476 :     LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1;
    6383             : 
    6384        1476 :     return oldXLogAllowed;
    6385             : }
    6386             : 
    6387             : /*
    6388             :  * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
    6389             :  *
    6390             :  * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
    6391             :  */
    6392             : XLogRecPtr
    6393      365442 : GetRedoRecPtr(void)
    6394             : {
    6395             :     XLogRecPtr  ptr;
    6396             : 
    6397             :     /*
    6398             :      * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
    6399             :      * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
    6400             :      * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
    6401             :      * the lock.
    6402             :      */
    6403      365442 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6404      365442 :     ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
    6405      365442 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6406             : 
    6407      365442 :     if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
    6408        1570 :         RedoRecPtr = ptr;
    6409             : 
    6410      365442 :     return RedoRecPtr;
    6411             : }
    6412             : 
    6413             : /*
    6414             :  * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
    6415             :  * full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
    6416             :  *
    6417             :  * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
    6418             :  * possibly out-of-date or, indeed, uninitialized, in which case they will
    6419             :  * be InvalidXLogRecPtr and false, respectively.  XLogInsertRecord will
    6420             :  * re-check them against up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
    6421             :  */
    6422             : void
    6423    25804650 : GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
    6424             : {
    6425    25804650 :     *RedoRecPtr_p = RedoRecPtr;
    6426    25804650 :     *doPageWrites_p = doPageWrites;
    6427    25804650 : }
    6428             : 
    6429             : /*
    6430             :  * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
    6431             :  *
    6432             :  * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
    6433             :  * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
    6434             :  * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
    6435             :  * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
    6436             :  */
    6437             : XLogRecPtr
    6438        3898 : GetInsertRecPtr(void)
    6439             : {
    6440             :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    6441             : 
    6442        3898 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6443        3898 :     recptr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
    6444        3898 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    6445             : 
    6446        3898 :     return recptr;
    6447             : }
    6448             : 
    6449             : /*
    6450             :  * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
    6451             :  * position known to be fsync'd to disk. This should only be used on a
    6452             :  * system that is known not to be in recovery.
    6453             :  */
    6454             : XLogRecPtr
    6455      299414 : GetFlushRecPtr(TimeLineID *insertTLI)
    6456             : {
    6457             :     Assert(XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState == RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6458             : 
    6459      299414 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    6460             : 
    6461             :     /*
    6462             :      * If we're writing and flushing WAL, the time line can't be changing, so
    6463             :      * no lock is required.
    6464             :      */
    6465      299414 :     if (insertTLI)
    6466       47642 :         *insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6467             : 
    6468      299414 :     return LogwrtResult.Flush;
    6469             : }
    6470             : 
    6471             : /*
    6472             :  * GetWALInsertionTimeLine -- Returns the current timeline of a system that
    6473             :  * is not in recovery.
    6474             :  */
    6475             : TimeLineID
    6476      105402 : GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
    6477             : {
    6478             :     Assert(XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState == RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
    6479             : 
    6480             :     /* Since the value can't be changing, no lock is required. */
    6481      105402 :     return XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6482             : }
    6483             : 
    6484             : /*
    6485             :  * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
    6486             :  * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
    6487             :  * important.
    6488             :  *
    6489             :  * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
    6490             :  * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
    6491             :  */
    6492             : XLogRecPtr
    6493        1670 : GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
    6494             : {
    6495        1670 :     XLogRecPtr  res = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    6496             :     int         i;
    6497             : 
    6498       15030 :     for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
    6499             :     {
    6500             :         XLogRecPtr  last_important;
    6501             : 
    6502             :         /*
    6503             :          * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
    6504             :          * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
    6505             :          * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
    6506             :          */
    6507       13360 :         LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6508       13360 :         last_important = WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt;
    6509       13360 :         LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
    6510             : 
    6511       13360 :         if (res < last_important)
    6512        2668 :             res = last_important;
    6513             :     }
    6514             : 
    6515        1670 :     return res;
    6516             : }
    6517             : 
    6518             : /*
    6519             :  * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
    6520             :  */
    6521             : pg_time_t
    6522           0 : GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
    6523             : {
    6524             :     pg_time_t   result;
    6525             : 
    6526             :     /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
    6527           0 :     LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_SHARED);
    6528           0 :     result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
    6529           0 :     *lastSwitchLSN = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN;
    6530           0 :     LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
    6531             : 
    6532           0 :     return result;
    6533             : }
    6534             : 
    6535             : /*
    6536             :  * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
    6537             :  */
    6538             : void
    6539        1000 : ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
    6540             : {
    6541             :     /*
    6542             :      * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
    6543             :      * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
    6544             :      */
    6545             :     Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL);
    6546             :     Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
    6547             :            CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner);
    6548        1000 :     CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner;
    6549             : 
    6550             :     /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
    6551        1000 :     ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE,
    6552             :             (errmsg("shutting down")));
    6553             : 
    6554             :     /*
    6555             :      * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
    6556             :      */
    6557        1000 :     WalSndInitStopping();
    6558             : 
    6559             :     /*
    6560             :      * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state.  This prevents commands
    6561             :      * from writing new WAL.
    6562             :      */
    6563        1000 :     WalSndWaitStopping();
    6564             : 
    6565        1000 :     if (RecoveryInProgress())
    6566          94 :         CreateRestartPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE);
    6567             :     else
    6568             :     {
    6569             :         /*
    6570             :          * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
    6571             :          * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
    6572             :          * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
    6573             :          * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
    6574             :          */
    6575         906 :         if (XLogArchivingActive())
    6576          22 :             RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    6577             : 
    6578         906 :         CreateCheckPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE);
    6579             :     }
    6580        1000 : }
    6581             : 
    6582             : /*
    6583             :  * Log start of a checkpoint.
    6584             :  */
    6585             : static void
    6586        1240 : LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
    6587             : {
    6588        1240 :     if (restartpoint)
    6589          76 :         ereport(LOG,
    6590             :         /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
    6591             :                 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
    6592             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
    6593             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
    6594             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE) ? " immediate" : "",
    6595             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
    6596             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
    6597             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
    6598             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
    6599             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL) ? " flush-all" : "")));
    6600             :     else
    6601        1164 :         ereport(LOG,
    6602             :         /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
    6603             :                 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
    6604             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
    6605             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
    6606             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE) ? " immediate" : "",
    6607             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
    6608             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
    6609             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
    6610             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
    6611             :                         (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL) ? " flush-all" : "")));
    6612        1240 : }
    6613             : 
    6614             : /*
    6615             :  * Log end of a checkpoint.
    6616             :  */
    6617             : static void
    6618        1704 : LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint)
    6619             : {
    6620             :     long        write_msecs,
    6621             :                 sync_msecs,
    6622             :                 total_msecs,
    6623             :                 longest_msecs,
    6624             :                 average_msecs;
    6625             :     uint64      average_sync_time;
    6626             : 
    6627        1704 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    6628             : 
    6629        1704 :     write_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t,
    6630             :                                                   CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t);
    6631             : 
    6632        1704 :     sync_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t,
    6633             :                                                  CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t);
    6634             : 
    6635             :     /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
    6636        1704 :     PendingCheckpointerStats.write_time += write_msecs;
    6637        1704 :     PendingCheckpointerStats.sync_time += sync_msecs;
    6638             : 
    6639             :     /*
    6640             :      * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for.  Only
    6641             :      * continue if a log message is to be written.
    6642             :      */
    6643        1704 :     if (!log_checkpoints)
    6644         464 :         return;
    6645             : 
    6646        1240 :     total_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t,
    6647             :                                                   CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t);
    6648             : 
    6649             :     /*
    6650             :      * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
    6651             :      * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
    6652             :      */
    6653        1240 :     longest_msecs = (long) ((CheckpointStats.ckpt_longest_sync + 999) / 1000);
    6654             : 
    6655        1240 :     average_sync_time = 0;
    6656        1240 :     if (CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels > 0)
    6657           0 :         average_sync_time = CheckpointStats.ckpt_agg_sync_time /
    6658           0 :             CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels;
    6659        1240 :     average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
    6660             : 
    6661             :     /*
    6662             :      * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
    6663             :      * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
    6664             :      * this moment.
    6665             :      */
    6666        1240 :     if (restartpoint)
    6667          76 :         ereport(LOG,
    6668             :                 (errmsg("restartpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%); "
    6669             :                         "%d WAL file(s) added, %d removed, %d recycled; "
    6670             :                         "write=%ld.%03d s, sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; "
    6671             :                         "sync files=%d, longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; "
    6672             :                         "distance=%d kB, estimate=%d kB; "
    6673             :                         "lsn=%X/%X, redo lsn=%X/%X",
    6674             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    6675             :                         (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers,
    6676             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    6677             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    6678             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled,
    6679             :                         write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
    6680             :                         sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
    6681             :                         total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
    6682             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels,
    6683             :                         longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
    6684             :                         average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
    6685             :                         (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
    6686             :                         (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
    6687             :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPoint),
    6688             :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo))));
    6689             :     else
    6690        1164 :         ereport(LOG,
    6691             :                 (errmsg("checkpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%); "
    6692             :                         "%d WAL file(s) added, %d removed, %d recycled; "
    6693             :                         "write=%ld.%03d s, sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; "
    6694             :                         "sync files=%d, longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; "
    6695             :                         "distance=%d kB, estimate=%d kB; "
    6696             :                         "lsn=%X/%X, redo lsn=%X/%X",
    6697             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    6698             :                         (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers,
    6699             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    6700             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    6701             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled,
    6702             :                         write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
    6703             :                         sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
    6704             :                         total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
    6705             :                         CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels,
    6706             :                         longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
    6707             :                         average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
    6708             :                         (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
    6709             :                         (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
    6710             :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPoint),
    6711             :                         LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo))));
    6712             : }
    6713             : 
    6714             : /*
    6715             :  * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
    6716             :  *
    6717             :  * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
    6718             :  * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
    6719             :  */
    6720             : static void
    6721        1704 : UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
    6722             : {
    6723             :     /*
    6724             :      * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
    6725             :      * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
    6726             :      * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
    6727             :      * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
    6728             :      * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
    6729             :      * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
    6730             :      * more.
    6731             :      *
    6732             :      * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
    6733             :      * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
    6734             :      *
    6735             :      * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
    6736             :      * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
    6737             :      * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
    6738             :      * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
    6739             :      * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
    6740             :      * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
    6741             :      * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
    6742             :      * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
    6743             :      * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
    6744             :      */
    6745        1704 :     PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
    6746        1704 :     if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
    6747        1084 :         CheckPointDistanceEstimate = nbytes;
    6748             :     else
    6749         620 :         CheckPointDistanceEstimate =
    6750         620 :             (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
    6751        1704 : }
    6752             : 
    6753             : /*
    6754             :  * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint.  Note that
    6755             :  * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called
    6756             :  * from a critical section.
    6757             :  */
    6758             : static void
    6759        3408 : update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
    6760             : {
    6761             :     /*
    6762             :      * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
    6763             :      * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints.  Updating the ps display is
    6764             :      * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
    6765             :      * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
    6766             :      * process.
    6767             :      */
    6768        3408 :     if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)) == 0)
    6769        1412 :         return;
    6770             : 
    6771        1996 :     if (reset)
    6772         998 :         set_ps_display("");
    6773             :     else
    6774             :     {
    6775             :         char        activitymsg[128];
    6776             : 
    6777        2994 :         snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
    6778         998 :                  (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
    6779         998 :                  (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
    6780             :                  restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
    6781         998 :         set_ps_display(activitymsg);
    6782             :     }
    6783             : }
    6784             : 
    6785             : 
    6786             : /*
    6787             :  * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
    6788             :  *
    6789             :  * flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
    6790             :  *  CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
    6791             :  *  CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
    6792             :  *  CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE: finish the checkpoint ASAP,
    6793             :  *      ignoring checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
    6794             :  *  CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
    6795             :  *      since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
    6796             :  *      CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
    6797             :  *  CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
    6798             :  *
    6799             :  * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
    6800             :  * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
    6801             :  * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
    6802             :  *
    6803             :  * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. An XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    6804             :  * record is inserted into WAL at the logical location of the checkpoint, before
    6805             :  * flushing anything to disk, and when the checkpoint is eventually completed,
    6806             :  * and it is from this point that WAL replay will begin in the case of a recovery
    6807             :  * from this checkpoint. Once everything is written to disk, an
    6808             :  * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE record is written to complete the checkpoint, and
    6809             :  * points back to the earlier XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO record. This mechanism allows
    6810             :  * other write-ahead log records to be written while the checkpoint is in
    6811             :  * progress, but we must be very careful about order of operations. This function
    6812             :  * may take many minutes to execute on a busy system.
    6813             :  *
    6814             :  * On the other hand, when shutdown is true, concurrent insertion into the
    6815             :  * write-ahead log is impossible, so there is no need for two separate records.
    6816             :  * In this case, we only insert an XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record, and it's
    6817             :  * both the record marking the completion of the checkpoint and the location
    6818             :  * from which WAL replay would begin if needed.
    6819             :  */
    6820             : void
    6821        1628 : CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
    6822             : {
    6823             :     bool        shutdown;
    6824             :     CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    6825             :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    6826             :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    6827        1628 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    6828             :     uint32      freespace;
    6829             :     XLogRecPtr  PriorRedoPtr;
    6830             :     XLogRecPtr  last_important_lsn;
    6831             :     VirtualTransactionId *vxids;
    6832             :     int         nvxids;
    6833        1628 :     int         oldXLogAllowed = 0;
    6834             : 
    6835             :     /*
    6836             :      * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
    6837             :      * issued at a different time.
    6838             :      */
    6839        1628 :     if (flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY))
    6840         962 :         shutdown = true;
    6841             :     else
    6842         666 :         shutdown = false;
    6843             : 
    6844             :     /* sanity check */
    6845        1628 :     if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
    6846           0 :         elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
    6847             : 
    6848             :     /*
    6849             :      * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
    6850             :      *
    6851             :      * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
    6852             :      * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
    6853             :      * log_checkpoints is currently off.
    6854             :      */
    6855       17908 :     MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
    6856        1628 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    6857             : 
    6858             :     /*
    6859             :      * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
    6860             :      * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer.  Note that
    6861             :      * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
    6862             :      * checkpoint is needed.
    6863             :      */
    6864        1628 :     SyncPreCheckpoint();
    6865             : 
    6866             :     /*
    6867             :      * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
    6868             :      */
    6869        1628 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    6870             : 
    6871        1628 :     if (shutdown)
    6872             :     {
    6873         962 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    6874         962 :         ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNING;
    6875         962 :         UpdateControlFile();
    6876         962 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    6877             :     }
    6878             : 
    6879             :     /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
    6880       19536 :     MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
    6881        1628 :     checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    6882             : 
    6883             :     /*
    6884             :      * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
    6885             :      * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
    6886             :      * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
    6887             :      */
    6888        1628 :     if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
    6889         614 :         checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId();
    6890             :     else
    6891        1014 :         checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId;
    6892             : 
    6893             :     /*
    6894             :      * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
    6895             :      * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
    6896             :      */
    6897        1628 :     last_important_lsn = GetLastImportantRecPtr();
    6898             : 
    6899             :     /*
    6900             :      * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
    6901             :      * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it.  The idea here is to
    6902             :      * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
    6903             :      */
    6904        1628 :     if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY |
    6905             :                   CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
    6906             :     {
    6907          52 :         if (last_important_lsn == ControlFile->checkPoint)
    6908             :         {
    6909           0 :             END_CRIT_SECTION();
    6910           0 :             ereport(DEBUG1,
    6911             :                     (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
    6912           0 :             return;
    6913             :         }
    6914             :     }
    6915             : 
    6916             :     /*
    6917             :      * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
    6918             :      * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
    6919             :      * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
    6920             :      */
    6921        1628 :     if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    6922          56 :         oldXLogAllowed = LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
    6923             : 
    6924        1628 :     checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    6925        1628 :     if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    6926          56 :         checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
    6927             :     else
    6928        1572 :         checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
    6929             : 
    6930             :     /*
    6931             :      * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
    6932             :      */
    6933        1628 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    6934             : 
    6935        1628 :     checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
    6936             : 
    6937        1628 :     if (shutdown)
    6938             :     {
    6939         962 :         XLogRecPtr  curInsert = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(Insert->CurrBytePos);
    6940             : 
    6941             :         /*
    6942             :          * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
    6943             :          *
    6944             :          * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
    6945             :          * WAL insertion.
    6946             :          */
    6947         962 :         freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
    6948         962 :         if (freespace == 0)
    6949             :         {
    6950           0 :             if (XLogSegmentOffset(curInsert, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    6951           0 :                 curInsert += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    6952             :             else
    6953           0 :                 curInsert += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    6954             :         }
    6955         962 :         checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
    6956             : 
    6957             :         /*
    6958             :          * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
    6959             :          * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
    6960             :          *
    6961             :          * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
    6962             :          * left pointing past where it really needs to point.  This is okay;
    6963             :          * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
    6964             :          * that it didn't really need to.  We can't postpone advancing
    6965             :          * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
    6966             :          * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
    6967             :          * the checkpoint.
    6968             :          */
    6969         962 :         RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    6970             :     }
    6971             : 
    6972             :     /*
    6973             :      * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
    6974             :      * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
    6975             :      */
    6976        1628 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    6977             : 
    6978             :     /*
    6979             :      * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
    6980             :      * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    6981             :      * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
    6982             :      * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
    6983             :      * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
    6984             :      * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
    6985             :      * mark the redo point.
    6986             :      */
    6987        1628 :     if (!shutdown)
    6988             :     {
    6989         666 :         int         dummy = 0;
    6990             : 
    6991             :         /* Record must have payload to avoid assertion failure. */
    6992         666 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    6993         666 :         XLogRegisterData((char *) &dummy, sizeof(dummy));
    6994         666 :         (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO);
    6995             : 
    6996             :         /*
    6997             :          * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
    6998             :          * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
    6999             :          * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
    7000             :          * checkpoint is complete.
    7001             :          */
    7002         666 :         checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
    7003             :     }
    7004             : 
    7005             :     /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
    7006        1628 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7007        1628 :     XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
    7008        1628 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7009             : 
    7010             :     /*
    7011             :      * If enabled, log checkpoint start.  We postpone this until now so as not
    7012             :      * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
    7013             :      */
    7014        1628 :     if (log_checkpoints)
    7015        1164 :         LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
    7016             : 
    7017             :     /* Update the process title */
    7018        1628 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
    7019             : 
    7020             :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
    7021             : 
    7022             :     /*
    7023             :      * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
    7024             :      *
    7025             :      * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
    7026             :      * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
    7027             :      * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
    7028             :      * there.
    7029             :      */
    7030        1628 :     LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
    7031        1628 :     checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
    7032        1628 :     checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
    7033        1628 :     checkPoint.oldestXidDB = TransamVariables->oldestXidDB;
    7034        1628 :     LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    7035             : 
    7036        1628 :     LWLockAcquire(CommitTsLock, LW_SHARED);
    7037        1628 :     checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = TransamVariables->oldestCommitTsXid;
    7038        1628 :     checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = TransamVariables->newestCommitTsXid;
    7039        1628 :     LWLockRelease(CommitTsLock);
    7040             : 
    7041        1628 :     LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
    7042        1628 :     checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
    7043        1628 :     if (!shutdown)
    7044         666 :         checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
    7045        1628 :     LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    7046             : 
    7047        1628 :     MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(shutdown,
    7048             :                              &checkPoint.nextMulti,
    7049             :                              &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
    7050             :                              &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    7051             :                              &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    7052             : 
    7053             :     /*
    7054             :      * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
    7055             :      * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
    7056             :      *
    7057             :      * This I/O could fail for various reasons.  If so, we will fail to
    7058             :      * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
    7059             :      * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
    7060             :      */
    7061        1628 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7062             : 
    7063             :     /*
    7064             :      * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
    7065             :      * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
    7066             :      * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
    7067             :      * performing those groups of actions.
    7068             :      *
    7069             :      * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
    7070             :      * that are currently in commit critical sections.  If an xact inserted
    7071             :      * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
    7072             :      * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
    7073             :      * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact.  So
    7074             :      * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
    7075             :      * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
    7076             :      *
    7077             :      * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
    7078             :      * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
    7079             :      * to wait for.  But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
    7080             :      * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
    7081             :      * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
    7082             :      * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
    7083             :      * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
    7084             :      * minimizing lock contention.)
    7085             :      *
    7086             :      * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
    7087             :      * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
    7088             :      * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
    7089             :      * clog and we will correctly flush the update below.  So we cannot miss
    7090             :      * any xacts we need to wait for.
    7091             :      */
    7092        1628 :     vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids, DELAY_CHKPT_START);
    7093        1628 :     if (nvxids > 0)
    7094             :     {
    7095             :         do
    7096             :         {
    7097          22 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_START);
    7098          22 :             pg_usleep(10000L);  /* wait for 10 msec */
    7099          22 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    7100          22 :         } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
    7101          22 :                                               DELAY_CHKPT_START));
    7102             :     }
    7103        1628 :     pfree(vxids);
    7104             : 
    7105        1628 :     CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
    7106             : 
    7107        1628 :     vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids, DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE);
    7108        1628 :     if (nvxids > 0)
    7109             :     {
    7110             :         do
    7111             :         {
    7112           0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_COMPLETE);
    7113           0 :             pg_usleep(10000L);  /* wait for 10 msec */
    7114           0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    7115           0 :         } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
    7116           0 :                                               DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE));
    7117             :     }
    7118        1628 :     pfree(vxids);
    7119             : 
    7120             :     /*
    7121             :      * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
    7122             :      * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
    7123             :      * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
    7124             :      *
    7125             :      * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
    7126             :      * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
    7127             :      */
    7128        1628 :     if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
    7129         614 :         LogStandbySnapshot();
    7130             : 
    7131        1628 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7132             : 
    7133             :     /*
    7134             :      * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
    7135             :      */
    7136        1628 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7137        1628 :     XLogRegisterData((char *) (&checkPoint), sizeof(checkPoint));
    7138        1628 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID,
    7139             :                         shutdown ? XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN :
    7140             :                         XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE);
    7141             : 
    7142        1628 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7143             : 
    7144             :     /*
    7145             :      * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
    7146             :      * overwritten at next startup.  No-one should even try, this just allows
    7147             :      * sanity-checking.  In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
    7148             :      * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
    7149             :      * recovery.
    7150             :      */
    7151        1628 :     if (shutdown)
    7152             :     {
    7153         962 :         if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    7154          56 :             LocalXLogInsertAllowed = oldXLogAllowed;
    7155             :         else
    7156         906 :             LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
    7157             :     }
    7158             : 
    7159             :     /*
    7160             :      * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
    7161             :      * = end of actual checkpoint record.
    7162             :      */
    7163        1628 :     if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
    7164           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    7165             :                 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
    7166             : 
    7167             :     /*
    7168             :      * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
    7169             :      * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
    7170             :      */
    7171        1628 :     PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    7172             : 
    7173             :     /*
    7174             :      * Update the control file.
    7175             :      */
    7176        1628 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7177        1628 :     if (shutdown)
    7178         962 :         ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED;
    7179        1628 :     ControlFile->checkPoint = ProcLastRecPtr;
    7180        1628 :     ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
    7181             :     /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
    7182        1628 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
    7183        1628 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = 0;
    7184             : 
    7185             :     /*
    7186             :      * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
    7187             :      * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
    7188             :      * for debugging purposes.
    7189             :      */
    7190        1628 :     ControlFile->unloggedLSN = pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(&XLogCtl->unloggedLSN);
    7191             : 
    7192        1628 :     UpdateControlFile();
    7193        1628 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7194             : 
    7195             :     /* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */
    7196        1628 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7197        1628 :     XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    7198        1628 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7199             : 
    7200             :     /*
    7201             :      * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
    7202             :      * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
    7203             :      */
    7204        1628 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7205             : 
    7206             :     /*
    7207             :      * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
    7208             :      * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
    7209             :      * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
    7210             :      * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
    7211             :      * happen before it can be summarized.
    7212             :      *
    7213             :      * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
    7214             :      * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
    7215             :      * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
    7216             :      * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
    7217             :      * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
    7218             :      * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
    7219             :      * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
    7220             :      * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
    7221             :      * record.
    7222             :      */
    7223        1628 :     SetWalSummarizerLatch();
    7224             : 
    7225             :     /*
    7226             :      * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
    7227             :      */
    7228        1628 :     SyncPostCheckpoint();
    7229             : 
    7230             :     /*
    7231             :      * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
    7232             :      * exists.
    7233             :      */
    7234        1628 :     if (PriorRedoPtr != InvalidXLogRecPtr)
    7235        1628 :         UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
    7236             : 
    7237             :     /*
    7238             :      * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
    7239             :      * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
    7240             :      */
    7241        1628 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7242        1628 :     KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
    7243        1628 :     if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED,
    7244             :                                            _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
    7245             :                                            InvalidTransactionId))
    7246             :     {
    7247             :         /*
    7248             :          * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
    7249             :          * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
    7250             :          */
    7251           6 :         XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7252           6 :         KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
    7253             :     }
    7254        1628 :     _logSegNo--;
    7255        1628 :     RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, recptr,
    7256             :                        checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
    7257             : 
    7258             :     /*
    7259             :      * Make more log segments if needed.  (Do this after recycling old log
    7260             :      * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
    7261             :      */
    7262        1628 :     if (!shutdown)
    7263         666 :         PreallocXlogFiles(recptr, checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
    7264             : 
    7265             :     /*
    7266             :      * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible.  We can throw away all data before
    7267             :      * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction.  No future transaction will
    7268             :      * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
    7269             :      * in subtrans.c).  During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
    7270             :      * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
    7271             :      */
    7272        1628 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7273        1572 :         TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
    7274             : 
    7275             :     /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
    7276        1628 :     LogCheckpointEnd(false);
    7277             : 
    7278             :     /* Reset the process title */
    7279        1628 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
    7280             : 
    7281             :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_DONE(CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
    7282             :                                      NBuffers,
    7283             :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added,
    7284             :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed,
    7285             :                                      CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled);
    7286             : }
    7287             : 
    7288             : /*
    7289             :  * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
    7290             :  * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
    7291             :  * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete.
    7292             :  *
    7293             :  * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
    7294             :  * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
    7295             :  */
    7296             : static void
    7297          76 : CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
    7298             : {
    7299             :     xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
    7300             :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7301             : 
    7302             :     /* sanity check */
    7303          76 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7304           0 :         elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
    7305             : 
    7306          76 :     xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7307             : 
    7308          76 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7309          76 :     xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7310          76 :     xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
    7311          76 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7312             : 
    7313          76 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7314             : 
    7315          76 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7316          76 :     XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
    7317          76 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY);
    7318             : 
    7319          76 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7320             : 
    7321             :     /*
    7322             :      * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
    7323             :      * changes to this point.
    7324             :      */
    7325          76 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7326          76 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = recptr;
    7327          76 :     ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
    7328          76 :     UpdateControlFile();
    7329          76 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7330             : 
    7331          76 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7332          76 : }
    7333             : 
    7334             : /*
    7335             :  * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message.
    7336             :  *
    7337             :  * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page
    7338             :  * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point.
    7339             :  * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record
    7340             :  * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical
    7341             :  * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind".  So the first action after
    7342             :  * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type
    7343             :  * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader
    7344             :  * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added
    7345             :  * to the page header where the record occurs.  xlogreader has an ad-hoc
    7346             :  * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we
    7347             :  * use here.
    7348             :  *
    7349             :  * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to
    7350             :  * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped
    7351             :  * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the
    7352             :  * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten.
    7353             :  *
    7354             :  * 'aborted_lsn' is the beginning position of the record that was incomplete.
    7355             :  * It is included in the WAL record.  'pagePtr' and 'newTLI' point to the
    7356             :  * beginning of the XLOG page where the record is to be inserted.  They must
    7357             :  * match the current WAL insert position, they're passed here just so that we
    7358             :  * can verify that.
    7359             :  */
    7360             : static XLogRecPtr
    7361          20 : CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr,
    7362             :                                 TimeLineID newTLI)
    7363             : {
    7364             :     xl_overwrite_contrecord xlrec;
    7365             :     XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    7366             :     XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
    7367             :     XLogRecPtr  startPos;
    7368             : 
    7369             :     /* sanity checks */
    7370          20 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7371           0 :         elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
    7372          20 :     if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
    7373           0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%X",
    7374             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(pagePtr));
    7375             : 
    7376             :     /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
    7377          20 :     startPos = pagePtr;
    7378          20 :     if (XLogSegmentOffset(startPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
    7379           2 :         startPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
    7380             :     else
    7381          18 :         startPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
    7382          20 :     recptr = GetXLogInsertRecPtr();
    7383          20 :     if (recptr != startPos)
    7384           0 :         elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
    7385             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recptr));
    7386             : 
    7387          20 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    7388             : 
    7389             :     /*
    7390             :      * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
    7391             :      * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
    7392             :      *
    7393             :      * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
    7394             :      * insertion lock is just pro forma.
    7395             :      */
    7396          20 :     WALInsertLockAcquire();
    7397          20 :     pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) GetXLogBuffer(pagePtr, newTLI);
    7398          20 :     pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD;
    7399          20 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7400             : 
    7401             :     /*
    7402             :      * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
    7403             :      * page.  We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
    7404             :      * allowed to write WAL yet.
    7405             :      */
    7406          20 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7407          20 :     xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
    7408          20 :     xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7409          20 :     XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_overwrite_contrecord));
    7410          20 :     recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD);
    7411             : 
    7412             :     /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
    7413          20 :     if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
    7414           0 :         elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%X",
    7415             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ProcLastRecPtr));
    7416             : 
    7417          20 :     XLogFlush(recptr);
    7418             : 
    7419          20 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    7420             : 
    7421          20 :     return recptr;
    7422             : }
    7423             : 
    7424             : /*
    7425             :  * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
    7426             :  *
    7427             :  * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
    7428             :  * recovery restartpoints.
    7429             :  */
    7430             : static void
    7431        1704 : CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
    7432             : {
    7433        1704 :     CheckPointRelationMap();
    7434        1704 :     CheckPointReplicationSlots(flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN);
    7435        1704 :     CheckPointSnapBuild();
    7436        1704 :     CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap();
    7437        1704 :     CheckPointReplicationOrigin();
    7438             : 
    7439             :     /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
    7440             :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
    7441        1704 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7442        1704 :     CheckPointCLOG();
    7443        1704 :     CheckPointCommitTs();
    7444        1704 :     CheckPointSUBTRANS();
    7445        1704 :     CheckPointMultiXact();
    7446        1704 :     CheckPointPredicate();
    7447        1704 :     CheckPointBuffers(flags);
    7448             : 
    7449             :     /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
    7450             :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_SYNC_START();
    7451        1704 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7452        1704 :     ProcessSyncRequests();
    7453        1704 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7454             :     TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_DONE();
    7455             : 
    7456             :     /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
    7457        1704 :     CheckPointTwoPhase(checkPointRedo);
    7458        1704 : }
    7459             : 
    7460             : /*
    7461             :  * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
    7462             :  *
    7463             :  * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
    7464             :  * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
    7465             :  * not.  If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
    7466             :  * CreateRestartPoint can consult it.  (Note that the latter function is
    7467             :  * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
    7468             :  * startup process.)
    7469             :  */
    7470             : static void
    7471         408 : RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
    7472             : {
    7473             :     /*
    7474             :      * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
    7475             :      * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
    7476             :      * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
    7477             :      * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
    7478             :      * later.
    7479             :      */
    7480         408 :     if (XLogHaveInvalidPages())
    7481             :     {
    7482           0 :         elog(DEBUG2,
    7483             :              "could not record restart point at %X/%X because there "
    7484             :              "are unresolved references to invalid pages",
    7485             :              LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
    7486           0 :         return;
    7487             :     }
    7488             : 
    7489             :     /*
    7490             :      * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
    7491             :      * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
    7492             :      */
    7493         408 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7494         408 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr = record->ReadRecPtr;
    7495         408 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr = record->EndRecPtr;
    7496         408 :     XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
    7497         408 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7498             : }
    7499             : 
    7500             : /*
    7501             :  * Establish a restartpoint if possible.
    7502             :  *
    7503             :  * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
    7504             :  * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
    7505             :  * replaying the entire recovery log.
    7506             :  *
    7507             :  * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
    7508             :  * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
    7509             :  * restartpoint.
    7510             :  */
    7511             : bool
    7512         170 : CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
    7513             : {
    7514             :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7515             :     XLogRecPtr  lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7516             :     CheckPoint  lastCheckPoint;
    7517             :     XLogRecPtr  PriorRedoPtr;
    7518             :     XLogRecPtr  receivePtr;
    7519             :     XLogRecPtr  replayPtr;
    7520             :     TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    7521             :     XLogRecPtr  endptr;
    7522             :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    7523             :     TimestampTz xtime;
    7524             : 
    7525             :     /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
    7526             :     Assert(!IsUnderPostmaster || MyBackendType == B_CHECKPOINTER);
    7527             : 
    7528             :     /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
    7529         170 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7530         170 :     lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7531         170 :     lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7532         170 :     lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
    7533         170 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7534             : 
    7535             :     /*
    7536             :      * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
    7537             :      * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
    7538             :      */
    7539         170 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7540             :     {
    7541           0 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    7542             :                 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
    7543           0 :         return false;
    7544             :     }
    7545             : 
    7546             :     /*
    7547             :      * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
    7548             :      * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
    7549             :      * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
    7550             :      * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
    7551             :      * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
    7552             :      * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
    7553             :      * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
    7554             :      * immediate shutdown, though.
    7555             :      *
    7556             :      * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
    7557             :      * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
    7558             :      * side-effect.
    7559             :      */
    7560         170 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
    7561         156 :         lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
    7562             :     {
    7563          94 :         ereport(DEBUG2,
    7564             :                 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%X",
    7565             :                                  LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo))));
    7566             : 
    7567          94 :         UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true);
    7568          94 :         if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
    7569             :         {
    7570          58 :             LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7571          58 :             ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
    7572          58 :             UpdateControlFile();
    7573          58 :             LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7574             :         }
    7575          94 :         return false;
    7576             :     }
    7577             : 
    7578             :     /*
    7579             :      * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
    7580             :      * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
    7581             :      * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
    7582             :      *
    7583             :      * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
    7584             :      * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
    7585             :      * happening.
    7586             :      */
    7587          76 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    7588          76 :     RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
    7589          76 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    7590             : 
    7591             :     /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
    7592          76 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7593          76 :     XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
    7594          76 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    7595             : 
    7596             :     /*
    7597             :      * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
    7598             :      *
    7599             :      * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
    7600             :      * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
    7601             :      * log_checkpoints is currently off.
    7602             :      */
    7603         836 :     MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats));
    7604          76 :     CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    7605             : 
    7606          76 :     if (log_checkpoints)
    7607          76 :         LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
    7608             : 
    7609             :     /* Update the process title */
    7610          76 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
    7611             : 
    7612          76 :     CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
    7613             : 
    7614             :     /*
    7615             :      * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
    7616             :      * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
    7617             :      */
    7618             :     INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point");
    7619             : 
    7620             :     /*
    7621             :      * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
    7622             :      * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
    7623             :      */
    7624          76 :     PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    7625             : 
    7626             :     /*
    7627             :      * Update pg_control, using current time.  Check that it still shows an
    7628             :      * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
    7629             :      * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
    7630             :      * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
    7631             :      */
    7632          76 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    7633          76 :     if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
    7634             :     {
    7635             :         /*
    7636             :          * Update the checkpoint information.  We do this even if the cluster
    7637             :          * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
    7638             :          * segments recycled below.
    7639             :          */
    7640          76 :         ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
    7641          76 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
    7642             : 
    7643             :         /*
    7644             :          * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
    7645             :          * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY.  Normally,
    7646             :          * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
    7647             :          * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied.  We do
    7648             :          * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
    7649             :          * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
    7650             :          * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
    7651             :          * included, at a minimum.  Note that for an ordinary restart of
    7652             :          * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
    7653             :          * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
    7654             :          * checkpoint record.
    7655             :          */
    7656          76 :         if (ControlFile->state == DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY)
    7657             :         {
    7658          76 :             if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
    7659             :             {
    7660          34 :                 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
    7661          34 :                 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = lastCheckPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
    7662             : 
    7663             :                 /* update local copy */
    7664          34 :                 LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    7665          34 :                 LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    7666             :             }
    7667          76 :             if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
    7668          36 :                 ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY;
    7669             :         }
    7670          76 :         UpdateControlFile();
    7671             :     }
    7672          76 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    7673             : 
    7674             :     /*
    7675             :      * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
    7676             :      * prior checkpoint exists.
    7677             :      */
    7678          76 :     if (PriorRedoPtr != InvalidXLogRecPtr)
    7679          76 :         UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr);
    7680             : 
    7681             :     /*
    7682             :      * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
    7683             :      * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
    7684             :      */
    7685          76 :     XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7686             : 
    7687             :     /*
    7688             :      * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
    7689             :      * whichever is later.
    7690             :      */
    7691          76 :     receivePtr = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(NULL, NULL);
    7692          76 :     replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    7693          76 :     endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
    7694          76 :     KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
    7695          76 :     if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED,
    7696             :                                            _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
    7697             :                                            InvalidTransactionId))
    7698             :     {
    7699             :         /*
    7700             :          * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
    7701             :          * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
    7702             :          */
    7703           2 :         XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7704           2 :         KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
    7705             :     }
    7706          76 :     _logSegNo--;
    7707             : 
    7708             :     /*
    7709             :      * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
    7710             :      * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
    7711             :      * at end of recovery.  If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
    7712             :      * currently replaying.
    7713             :      *
    7714             :      * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
    7715             :      * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
    7716             :      * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
    7717             :      * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
    7718             :      * with that.
    7719             :      */
    7720          76 :     if (!RecoveryInProgress())
    7721           0 :         replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    7722             : 
    7723          76 :     RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
    7724             : 
    7725             :     /*
    7726             :      * Make more log segments if needed.  (Do this after recycling old log
    7727             :      * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
    7728             :      */
    7729          76 :     PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
    7730             : 
    7731             :     /*
    7732             :      * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible.  We can throw away all data before
    7733             :      * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction.  No future transaction will
    7734             :      * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
    7735             :      * in subtrans.c).  When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
    7736             :      * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
    7737             :      */
    7738          76 :     if (EnableHotStandby)
    7739          76 :         TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning());
    7740             : 
    7741             :     /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
    7742          76 :     LogCheckpointEnd(true);
    7743             : 
    7744             :     /* Reset the process title */
    7745          76 :     update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
    7746             : 
    7747          76 :     xtime = GetLatestXTime();
    7748          76 :     ereport((log_checkpoints ? LOG : DEBUG2),
    7749             :             (errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%X",
    7750             :                     LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
    7751             :              xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
    7752             :                                timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0));
    7753             : 
    7754             :     /*
    7755             :      * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
    7756             :      */
    7757          76 :     if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0)
    7758           0 :         ExecuteRecoveryCommand(archiveCleanupCommand,
    7759             :                                "archive_cleanup_command",
    7760             :                                false,
    7761             :                                WAIT_EVENT_ARCHIVE_CLEANUP_COMMAND);
    7762             : 
    7763          76 :     return true;
    7764             : }
    7765             : 
    7766             : /*
    7767             :  * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
    7768             :  *      (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
    7769             :  *
    7770             :  * Returns one of the following enum values:
    7771             :  *
    7772             :  * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
    7773             :  *   max_wal_size.
    7774             :  *
    7775             :  * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
    7776             :  *   segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
    7777             :  *   than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
    7778             :  *
    7779             :  * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
    7780             :  *   remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
    7781             :  *   above.
    7782             :  *
    7783             :  * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
    7784             :  *   a slot with this LSN cannot continue.  (Any associated walsender
    7785             :  *   processes should have been terminated already.)
    7786             :  *
    7787             :  * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
    7788             :  */
    7789             : WALAvailability
    7790         832 : GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
    7791             : {
    7792             :     XLogRecPtr  currpos;        /* current write LSN */
    7793             :     XLogSegNo   currSeg;        /* segid of currpos */
    7794             :     XLogSegNo   targetSeg;      /* segid of targetLSN */
    7795             :     XLogSegNo   oldestSeg;      /* actual oldest segid */
    7796             :     XLogSegNo   oldestSegMaxWalSize;    /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
    7797             :     XLogSegNo   oldestSlotSeg;  /* oldest segid kept by slot */
    7798             :     uint64      keepSegs;
    7799             : 
    7800             :     /*
    7801             :      * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
    7802             :      */
    7803         832 :     if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(targetLSN))
    7804          22 :         return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
    7805             : 
    7806             :     /*
    7807             :      * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
    7808             :      * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size.  Initialize
    7809             :      * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
    7810             :      */
    7811         810 :     currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
    7812         810 :     XLByteToSeg(currpos, oldestSlotSeg, wal_segment_size);
    7813         810 :     KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
    7814             : 
    7815             :     /*
    7816             :      * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
    7817             :      * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
    7818             :      * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
    7819             :      */
    7820         810 :     oldestSeg = XLogGetLastRemovedSegno() + 1;
    7821             : 
    7822             :     /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
    7823         810 :     XLByteToSeg(currpos, currSeg, wal_segment_size);
    7824         810 :     keepSegs = ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) + 1;
    7825             : 
    7826         810 :     if (currSeg > keepSegs)
    7827          16 :         oldestSegMaxWalSize = currSeg - keepSegs;
    7828             :     else
    7829         794 :         oldestSegMaxWalSize = 1;
    7830             : 
    7831             :     /* the segment we care about */
    7832         810 :     XLByteToSeg(targetLSN, targetSeg, wal_segment_size);
    7833             : 
    7834             :     /*
    7835             :      * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
    7836             :      * targetSeg is known to be lost.
    7837             :      */
    7838         810 :     if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
    7839             :     {
    7840             :         /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
    7841         808 :         if (targetSeg >= oldestSegMaxWalSize)
    7842         804 :             return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
    7843             : 
    7844             :         /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
    7845           4 :         return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
    7846             :     }
    7847             : 
    7848             :     /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
    7849           2 :     if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
    7850           2 :         return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
    7851             : 
    7852             :     /* Definitely lost */
    7853           0 :     return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
    7854             : }
    7855             : 
    7856             : 
    7857             : /*
    7858             :  * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
    7859             :  * either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
    7860             :  *
    7861             :  * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
    7862             :  * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
    7863             :  * requirement of replication slots.  For the latter criterion we do consider
    7864             :  * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
    7865             :  * from recptr.
    7866             :  *
    7867             :  * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value
    7868             :  * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected
    7869             :  * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again.
    7870             :  * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that
    7871             :  * invalidation is optionally done here, instead.
    7872             :  */
    7873             : static void
    7874        2522 : KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
    7875             : {
    7876             :     XLogSegNo   currSegNo;
    7877             :     XLogSegNo   segno;
    7878             :     XLogRecPtr  keep;
    7879             : 
    7880        2522 :     XLByteToSeg(recptr, currSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    7881        2522 :     segno = currSegNo;
    7882             : 
    7883             :     /*
    7884             :      * Calculate how many segments are kept by slots first, adjusting for
    7885             :      * max_slot_wal_keep_size.
    7886             :      */
    7887        2522 :     keep = XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN();
    7888        2522 :     if (keep != InvalidXLogRecPtr && keep < recptr)
    7889             :     {
    7890         704 :         XLByteToSeg(keep, segno, wal_segment_size);
    7891             : 
    7892             :         /* Cap by max_slot_wal_keep_size ... */
    7893         704 :         if (max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb >= 0)
    7894             :         {
    7895             :             uint64      slot_keep_segs;
    7896             : 
    7897          40 :             slot_keep_segs =
    7898          40 :                 ConvertToXSegs(max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
    7899             : 
    7900          40 :             if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
    7901          10 :                 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
    7902             :         }
    7903             :     }
    7904             : 
    7905             :     /*
    7906             :      * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
    7907             :      * summarized.
    7908             :      */
    7909        2522 :     keep = GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(NULL, NULL, false);
    7910        2522 :     if (keep != InvalidXLogRecPtr)
    7911             :     {
    7912             :         XLogSegNo   unsummarized_segno;
    7913             : 
    7914           0 :         XLByteToSeg(keep, unsummarized_segno, wal_segment_size);
    7915           0 :         if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
    7916           0 :             segno = unsummarized_segno;
    7917             :     }
    7918             : 
    7919             :     /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
    7920        2522 :     if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
    7921             :     {
    7922             :         uint64      keep_segs;
    7923             : 
    7924         122 :         keep_segs = ConvertToXSegs(wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size);
    7925         122 :         if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
    7926             :         {
    7927             :             /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
    7928         122 :             if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
    7929         114 :                 segno = 1;
    7930             :             else
    7931           8 :                 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
    7932             :         }
    7933             :     }
    7934             : 
    7935             :     /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
    7936        2522 :     if (segno < *logSegNo)
    7937         330 :         *logSegNo = segno;
    7938        2522 : }
    7939             : 
    7940             : /*
    7941             :  * Write a NEXTOID log record
    7942             :  */
    7943             : void
    7944         992 : XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
    7945             : {
    7946         992 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7947         992 :     XLogRegisterData((char *) (&nextOid), sizeof(Oid));
    7948         992 :     (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTOID);
    7949             : 
    7950             :     /*
    7951             :      * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
    7952             :      * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
    7953             :      * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
    7954             :      * record.  Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
    7955             :      * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
    7956             :      * does.
    7957             :      *
    7958             :      * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
    7959             :      * database.  When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
    7960             :      * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
    7961             :      * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does.  The impact
    7962             :      * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
    7963             :      * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
    7964             :      * with the leftover file or directory.  But since for safety's sake we
    7965             :      * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
    7966             :      * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
    7967             :      */
    7968         992 : }
    7969             : 
    7970             : /*
    7971             :  * Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
    7972             :  *
    7973             :  * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
    7974             :  * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
    7975             :  *
    7976             :  * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
    7977             :  * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
    7978             :  * write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
    7979             :  */
    7980             : XLogRecPtr
    7981         666 : RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
    7982             : {
    7983             :     XLogRecPtr  RecPtr;
    7984             : 
    7985             :     /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
    7986         666 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    7987             : 
    7988         666 :     if (mark_unimportant)
    7989           0 :         XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT);
    7990         666 :     RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_SWITCH);
    7991             : 
    7992         666 :     return RecPtr;
    7993             : }
    7994             : 
    7995             : /*
    7996             :  * Write a RESTORE POINT record
    7997             :  */
    7998             : XLogRecPtr
    7999           6 : XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
    8000             : {
    8001             :     XLogRecPtr  RecPtr;
    8002             :     xl_restore_point xlrec;
    8003             : 
    8004           6 :     xlrec.rp_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
    8005           6 :     strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
    8006             : 
    8007           6 :     XLogBeginInsert();
    8008           6 :     XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_restore_point));
    8009             : 
    8010           6 :     RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_RESTORE_POINT);
    8011             : 
    8012           6 :     ereport(LOG,
    8013             :             (errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%X",
    8014             :                     rpName, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(RecPtr))));
    8015             : 
    8016           6 :     return RecPtr;
    8017             : }
    8018             : 
    8019             : /*
    8020             :  * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
    8021             :  * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
    8022             :  */
    8023             : static void
    8024        1420 : XLogReportParameters(void)
    8025             : {
    8026        1420 :     if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level ||
    8027        1048 :         wal_log_hints != ControlFile->wal_log_hints ||
    8028         906 :         MaxConnections != ControlFile->MaxConnections ||
    8029         904 :         max_worker_processes != ControlFile->max_worker_processes ||
    8030         902 :         max_wal_senders != ControlFile->max_wal_senders ||
    8031         880 :         max_prepared_xacts != ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts ||
    8032         718 :         max_locks_per_xact != ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact ||
    8033         718 :         track_commit_timestamp != ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp)
    8034             :     {
    8035             :         /*
    8036             :          * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
    8037             :          * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
    8038             :          * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
    8039             :          * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
    8040             :          * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
    8041             :          */
    8042         716 :         if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level || XLogIsNeeded())
    8043             :         {
    8044             :             xl_parameter_change xlrec;
    8045             :             XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    8046             : 
    8047         700 :             xlrec.MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    8048         700 :             xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    8049         700 :             xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    8050         700 :             xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    8051         700 :             xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    8052         700 :             xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
    8053         700 :             xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    8054         700 :             xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    8055             : 
    8056         700 :             XLogBeginInsert();
    8057         700 :             XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
    8058             : 
    8059         700 :             recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE);
    8060         700 :             XLogFlush(recptr);
    8061             :         }
    8062             : 
    8063         716 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8064             : 
    8065         716 :         ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections;
    8066         716 :         ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
    8067         716 :         ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
    8068         716 :         ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
    8069         716 :         ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
    8070         716 :         ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level;
    8071         716 :         ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
    8072         716 :         ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
    8073         716 :         UpdateControlFile();
    8074             : 
    8075         716 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8076             :     }
    8077        1420 : }
    8078             : 
    8079             : /*
    8080             :  * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
    8081             :  * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
    8082             :  *
    8083             :  * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
    8084             :  * concurrently that could update it.
    8085             :  */
    8086             : void
    8087        2344 : UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
    8088             : {
    8089        2344 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    8090             :     bool        recoveryInProgress;
    8091             : 
    8092             :     /*
    8093             :      * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
    8094             :      *
    8095             :      * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
    8096             :      * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
    8097             :      * can update it.
    8098             :      */
    8099        2344 :     if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
    8100        1536 :         return;
    8101             : 
    8102             :     /*
    8103             :      * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
    8104             :      * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
    8105             :      * assertion failure.
    8106             :      */
    8107         808 :     recoveryInProgress = RecoveryInProgress();
    8108             : 
    8109         808 :     START_CRIT_SECTION();
    8110             : 
    8111             :     /*
    8112             :      * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
    8113             :      * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
    8114             :      * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
    8115             :      * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
    8116             :      * flag.
    8117             :      */
    8118         808 :     if (fullPageWrites)
    8119             :     {
    8120         800 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8121         800 :         Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
    8122         800 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    8123             :     }
    8124             : 
    8125             :     /*
    8126             :      * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
    8127             :      * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
    8128             :      */
    8129         808 :     if (XLogStandbyInfoActive() && !recoveryInProgress)
    8130             :     {
    8131           0 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    8132           0 :         XLogRegisterData((char *) (&fullPageWrites), sizeof(bool));
    8133             : 
    8134           0 :         XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_FPW_CHANGE);
    8135             :     }
    8136             : 
    8137         808 :     if (!fullPageWrites)
    8138             :     {
    8139           8 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8140           8 :         Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
    8141           8 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    8142             :     }
    8143         808 :     END_CRIT_SECTION();
    8144             : }
    8145             : 
    8146             : /*
    8147             :  * XLOG resource manager's routines
    8148             :  *
    8149             :  * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
    8150             :  * not all record types are related to control file updates.
    8151             :  *
    8152             :  * NOTE: Some XLOG record types that are directly related to WAL recovery
    8153             :  * are handled in xlogrecovery_redo().
    8154             :  */
    8155             : void
    8156       56652 : xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
    8157             : {
    8158       56652 :     uint8       info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
    8159       56652 :     XLogRecPtr  lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
    8160             : 
    8161             :     /*
    8162             :      * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
    8163             :      * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
    8164             :      */
    8165             :     Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
    8166             :            !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
    8167             : 
    8168       56652 :     if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
    8169             :     {
    8170             :         Oid         nextOid;
    8171             : 
    8172             :         /*
    8173             :          * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
    8174             :          * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
    8175             :          * around.  Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
    8176             :          * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly.  We still take
    8177             :          * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
    8178             :          */
    8179         156 :         memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
    8180         156 :         LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8181         156 :         TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
    8182         156 :         TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    8183         156 :         LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    8184             :     }
    8185       56496 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
    8186             :     {
    8187             :         CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    8188             :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8189             : 
    8190          58 :         memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
    8191             :         /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
    8192          58 :         LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8193          58 :         TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8194          58 :         LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    8195          58 :         LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8196          58 :         TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
    8197          58 :         TransamVariables->oidCount = 0;
    8198          58 :         LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
    8199          58 :         MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
    8200             :                               checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    8201             : 
    8202          58 :         MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    8203             :                                checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    8204             : 
    8205             :         /*
    8206             :          * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
    8207             :          * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
    8208             :          */
    8209          58 :         SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    8210             : 
    8211             :         /*
    8212             :          * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
    8213             :          * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
    8214             :          * never arrive.
    8215             :          */
    8216          58 :         if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested &&
    8217          58 :             !XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) &&
    8218           0 :             XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupEndPoint))
    8219           0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8220             :                     (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
    8221             : 
    8222             :         /*
    8223             :          * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
    8224             :          * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
    8225             :          * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
    8226             :          * for prepared transactions.
    8227             :          */
    8228          58 :         if (standbyState >= STANDBY_INITIALIZED)
    8229             :         {
    8230             :             TransactionId *xids;
    8231             :             int         nxids;
    8232             :             TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
    8233             :             TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
    8234             :             RunningTransactionsData running;
    8235             : 
    8236          54 :             oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
    8237             : 
    8238             :             /*
    8239             :              * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
    8240             :              * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
    8241             :              * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
    8242             :              * with their parent prepared transactions.
    8243             :              */
    8244          54 :             running.xcnt = nxids;
    8245          54 :             running.subxcnt = 0;
    8246          54 :             running.subxid_overflow = false;
    8247          54 :             running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    8248          54 :             running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
    8249          54 :             latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
    8250          54 :             TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
    8251             :             Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
    8252          54 :             running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
    8253          54 :             running.xids = xids;
    8254             : 
    8255          54 :             ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running);
    8256             : 
    8257          54 :             StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions();
    8258             :         }
    8259             : 
    8260             :         /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
    8261          58 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8262          58 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8263          58 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8264             : 
    8265             :         /* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */
    8266          58 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8267          58 :         XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8268          58 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8269             : 
    8270             :         /*
    8271             :          * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
    8272             :          * record.
    8273             :          */
    8274          58 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8275          58 :         if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8276           0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8277             :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
    8278             :                             checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8279             : 
    8280          58 :         RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
    8281             :     }
    8282       56438 :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
    8283             :     {
    8284             :         CheckPoint  checkPoint;
    8285             :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8286             : 
    8287         350 :         memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
    8288             :         /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
    8289         350 :         LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8290         350 :         if (FullTransactionIdPrecedes(TransamVariables->nextXid,
    8291             :                                       checkPoint.nextXid))
    8292           0 :             TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8293         350 :         LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
    8294             : 
    8295             :         /*
    8296             :          * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
    8297             :          * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records.  The nextOid
    8298             :          * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
    8299             :          * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records.  We could try to take the
    8300             :          * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
    8301             :          * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
    8302             :          * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do.  In any case,
    8303             :          * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
    8304             :          * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
    8305             :          */
    8306             : 
    8307             :         /* Handle multixact */
    8308         350 :         MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti,
    8309             :                                   checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
    8310             : 
    8311             :         /*
    8312             :          * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
    8313             :          * generated by an older primary.
    8314             :          */
    8315         350 :         MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti,
    8316             :                                checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
    8317         350 :         if (TransactionIdPrecedes(TransamVariables->oldestXid,
    8318             :                                   checkPoint.oldestXid))
    8319           0 :             SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid,
    8320             :                                   checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
    8321             :         /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
    8322         350 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8323         350 :         ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8324         350 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8325             : 
    8326             :         /* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */
    8327         350 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8328         350 :         XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
    8329         350 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8330             : 
    8331             :         /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
    8332         350 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8333         350 :         if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8334           0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8335             :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
    8336             :                             checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8337             : 
    8338         350 :         RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
    8339             :     }
    8340       56088 :     else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
    8341             :     {
    8342             :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
    8343             :     }
    8344       56086 :     else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
    8345             :     {
    8346             :         xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
    8347             :         TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8348             : 
    8349          18 :         memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
    8350             : 
    8351             :         /*
    8352             :          * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
    8353             :          * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
    8354             :          * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
    8355             :          */
    8356             : 
    8357             :         /*
    8358             :          * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
    8359             :          * record.
    8360             :          */
    8361          18 :         (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8362          18 :         if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
    8363           0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8364             :                     (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
    8365             :                             xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
    8366             :     }
    8367       56068 :     else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
    8368             :     {
    8369             :         /* nothing to do here */
    8370             :     }
    8371       56068 :     else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
    8372             :     {
    8373             :         /* nothing to do here */
    8374             :     }
    8375       55850 :     else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
    8376             :     {
    8377             :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
    8378             :     }
    8379       55840 :     else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
    8380             :     {
    8381             :         /*
    8382             :          * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
    8383             :          * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
    8384             :          * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
    8385             :          * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
    8386             :          *
    8387             :          * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
    8388             :          * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
    8389             :          * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
    8390             :          * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
    8391             :          * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
    8392             :          *
    8393             :          * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
    8394             :          * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
    8395             :          * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
    8396             :          */
    8397      120146 :         for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
    8398             :         {
    8399             :             Buffer      buffer;
    8400             : 
    8401       64870 :             if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
    8402             :             {
    8403         136 :                 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
    8404           0 :                     elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
    8405         136 :                 continue;
    8406             :             }
    8407             : 
    8408       64734 :             if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
    8409           0 :                 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
    8410       64734 :             UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
    8411             :         }
    8412             :     }
    8413         564 :     else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
    8414             :     {
    8415             :         /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
    8416             :     }
    8417         412 :     else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
    8418             :     {
    8419             :         xl_parameter_change xlrec;
    8420             : 
    8421             :         /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
    8422          60 :         memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
    8423             : 
    8424             :         /*
    8425             :          * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the primary
    8426             :          * does not have a WAL level sufficient for logical decoding. No need
    8427             :          * to search for potentially conflicting logically slots if standby is
    8428             :          * running with wal_level lower than logical, because in that case, we
    8429             :          * would have either disallowed creation of logical slots or
    8430             :          * invalidated existing ones.
    8431             :          */
    8432          60 :         if (InRecovery && InHotStandby &&
    8433          28 :             xlrec.wal_level < WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL &&
    8434          12 :             wal_level >= WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL)
    8435           8 :             InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL,
    8436             :                                                0, InvalidOid,
    8437             :                                                InvalidTransactionId);
    8438             : 
    8439          60 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    8440          60 :         ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
    8441          60 :         ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
    8442          60 :         ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
    8443          60 :         ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
    8444          60 :         ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
    8445          60 :         ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
    8446          60 :         ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
    8447             : 
    8448             :         /*
    8449             :          * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
    8450             :          * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
    8451             :          * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
    8452             :          * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
    8453             :          * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
    8454             :          * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
    8455             :          */
    8456          60 :         if (InArchiveRecovery)
    8457             :         {
    8458          30 :             LocalMinRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    8459          30 :             LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    8460             :         }
    8461          60 :         if (LocalMinRecoveryPoint != InvalidXLogRecPtr && LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
    8462             :         {
    8463             :             TimeLineID  replayTLI;
    8464             : 
    8465          14 :             (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
    8466          14 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lsn;
    8467          14 :             ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
    8468             :         }
    8469             : 
    8470          60 :         CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
    8471          60 :                                 ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp);
    8472          60 :         ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
    8473             : 
    8474          60 :         UpdateControlFile();
    8475          60 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8476             : 
    8477             :         /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
    8478          60 :         CheckRequiredParameterValues();
    8479             :     }
    8480         352 :     else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
    8481             :     {
    8482             :         bool        fpw;
    8483             : 
    8484           0 :         memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
    8485             : 
    8486             :         /*
    8487             :          * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
    8488             :          * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
    8489             :          * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
    8490             :          */
    8491           0 :         if (!fpw)
    8492             :         {
    8493           0 :             SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8494           0 :             if (XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr < record->ReadRecPtr)
    8495           0 :                 XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr = record->ReadRecPtr;
    8496           0 :             SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8497             :         }
    8498             : 
    8499             :         /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
    8500           0 :         lastFullPageWrites = fpw;
    8501             :     }
    8502             :     else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
    8503             :     {
    8504             :         /* nothing to do here, just for informational purposes */
    8505             :     }
    8506       56648 : }
    8507             : 
    8508             : /*
    8509             :  * Return the extra open flags used for opening a file, depending on the
    8510             :  * value of the GUCs wal_sync_method, fsync and io_direct.
    8511             :  */
    8512             : static int
    8513       15608 : get_sync_bit(int method)
    8514             : {
    8515       15608 :     int         o_direct_flag = 0;
    8516             : 
    8517             :     /*
    8518             :      * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process.  The WAL
    8519             :      * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
    8520             :      * after it's written.  Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
    8521             :      * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
    8522             :      */
    8523       15608 :     if ((io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) && !AmWalReceiverProcess())
    8524          14 :         o_direct_flag = PG_O_DIRECT;
    8525             : 
    8526             :     /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
    8527       15608 :     if (!enableFsync)
    8528       15608 :         return o_direct_flag;
    8529             : 
    8530           0 :     switch (method)
    8531             :     {
    8532             :             /*
    8533             :              * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
    8534             :              * not supported on the current platform.  But if not, they are
    8535             :              * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
    8536             :              * be seen here.
    8537             :              */
    8538           0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
    8539             :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
    8540             :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
    8541           0 :             return o_direct_flag;
    8542             : #ifdef O_SYNC
    8543           0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
    8544           0 :             return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
    8545             : #endif
    8546             : #ifdef O_DSYNC
    8547           0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
    8548           0 :             return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
    8549             : #endif
    8550           0 :         default:
    8551             :             /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
    8552           0 :             elog(ERROR, "unrecognized wal_sync_method: %d", method);
    8553             :             return 0;           /* silence warning */
    8554             :     }
    8555             : }
    8556             : 
    8557             : /*
    8558             :  * GUC support
    8559             :  */
    8560             : void
    8561        1830 : assign_wal_sync_method(int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
    8562             : {
    8563        1830 :     if (wal_sync_method != new_wal_sync_method)
    8564             :     {
    8565             :         /*
    8566             :          * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
    8567             :          * currently open log segment (if any).  Also, if the open flag is
    8568             :          * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
    8569             :          * bit) at next use.
    8570             :          */
    8571           0 :         if (openLogFile >= 0)
    8572             :         {
    8573           0 :             pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD_ASSIGN);
    8574           0 :             if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
    8575             :             {
    8576             :                 char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    8577             :                 int         save_errno;
    8578             : 
    8579           0 :                 save_errno = errno;
    8580           0 :                 XLogFileName(xlogfname, openLogTLI, openLogSegNo,
    8581             :                              wal_segment_size);
    8582           0 :                 errno = save_errno;
    8583           0 :                 ereport(PANIC,
    8584             :                         (errcode_for_file_access(),
    8585             :                          errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
    8586             :             }
    8587             : 
    8588           0 :             pgstat_report_wait_end();
    8589           0 :             if (get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method) != get_sync_bit(new_wal_sync_method))
    8590           0 :                 XLogFileClose();
    8591             :         }
    8592             :     }
    8593        1830 : }
    8594             : 
    8595             : 
    8596             : /*
    8597             :  * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
    8598             :  *
    8599             :  * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
    8600             :  * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
    8601             :  */
    8602             : void
    8603      263892 : issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
    8604             : {
    8605      263892 :     char       *msg = NULL;
    8606             :     instr_time  start;
    8607             : 
    8608             :     Assert(tli != 0);
    8609             : 
    8610             :     /*
    8611             :      * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
    8612             :      * file.
    8613             :      */
    8614      263892 :     if (!enableFsync ||
    8615           0 :         wal_sync_method == WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN ||
    8616           0 :         wal_sync_method == WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC)
    8617      263892 :         return;
    8618             : 
    8619             :     /* Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file */
    8620           0 :     if (track_wal_io_timing)
    8621           0 :         INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(start);
    8622             :     else
    8623           0 :         INSTR_TIME_SET_ZERO(start);
    8624             : 
    8625           0 :     pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC);
    8626           0 :     switch (wal_sync_method)
    8627             :     {
    8628           0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC:
    8629           0 :             if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
    8630           0 :                 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
    8631           0 :             break;
    8632             : #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
    8633             :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH:
    8634             :             if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
    8635             :                 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
    8636             :             break;
    8637             : #endif
    8638           0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC:
    8639           0 :             if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
    8640           0 :                 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
    8641           0 :             break;
    8642           0 :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN:
    8643             :         case WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC:
    8644             :             /* not reachable */
    8645             :             Assert(false);
    8646           0 :             break;
    8647           0 :         default:
    8648           0 :             ereport(PANIC,
    8649             :                     errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    8650             :                     errmsg_internal("unrecognized wal_sync_method: %d", wal_sync_method));
    8651             :             break;
    8652             :     }
    8653             : 
    8654             :     /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
    8655           0 :     if (msg)
    8656             :     {
    8657             :         char        xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
    8658           0 :         int         save_errno = errno;
    8659             : 
    8660           0 :         XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
    8661           0 :         errno = save_errno;
    8662           0 :         ereport(PANIC,
    8663             :                 (errcode_for_file_access(),
    8664             :                  errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
    8665             :     }
    8666             : 
    8667           0 :     pgstat_report_wait_end();
    8668             : 
    8669             :     /*
    8670             :      * Increment the I/O timing and the number of times WAL files were synced.
    8671             :      */
    8672           0 :     if (track_wal_io_timing)
    8673             :     {
    8674             :         instr_time  end;
    8675             : 
    8676           0 :         INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(end);
    8677           0 :         INSTR_TIME_ACCUM_DIFF(PendingWalStats.wal_sync_time, end, start);
    8678             :     }
    8679             : 
    8680           0 :     PendingWalStats.wal_sync++;
    8681             : }
    8682             : 
    8683             : /*
    8684             :  * do_pg_backup_start is the workhorse of the user-visible pg_backup_start()
    8685             :  * function. It creates the necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the
    8686             :  * backup state and tablespace map.
    8687             :  *
    8688             :  * Input parameters are "state" (the backup state), "fast" (if true, we do
    8689             :  * the checkpoint in immediate mode to make it faster), and "tablespaces"
    8690             :  * (if non-NULL, indicates a list of tablespaceinfo structs describing the
    8691             :  * cluster's tablespaces.).
    8692             :  *
    8693             :  * The tablespace map contents are appended to passed-in parameter
    8694             :  * tablespace_map and the caller is responsible for including it in the backup
    8695             :  * archive as 'tablespace_map'. The tablespace_map file is required mainly for
    8696             :  * tar format in windows as native windows utilities are not able to create
    8697             :  * symlinks while extracting files from tar. However for consistency and
    8698             :  * platform-independence, we do it the same way everywhere.
    8699             :  *
    8700             :  * It fills in "state" with the information required for the backup, such
    8701             :  * as the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
    8702             :  * backup (starttli) and the corresponding timeline ID (starttli).
    8703             :  *
    8704             :  * Every successfully started backup must be stopped by calling
    8705             :  * do_pg_backup_stop() or do_pg_abort_backup(). There can be many
    8706             :  * backups active at the same time.
    8707             :  *
    8708             :  * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
    8709             :  * permissions of the calling user!
    8710             :  */
    8711             : void
    8712         290 : do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces,
    8713             :                    BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
    8714             : {
    8715             :     bool        backup_started_in_recovery;
    8716             : 
    8717             :     Assert(state != NULL);
    8718         290 :     backup_started_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
    8719             : 
    8720             :     /*
    8721             :      * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
    8722             :      * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
    8723             :      */
    8724         290 :     if (!backup_started_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
    8725           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8726             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    8727             :                  errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
    8728             :                  errhint("wal_level must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
    8729             : 
    8730         290 :     if (strlen(backupidstr) > MAXPGPATH)
    8731           2 :         ereport(ERROR,
    8732             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
    8733             :                  errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
    8734             :                         MAXPGPATH)));
    8735             : 
    8736         288 :     memcpy(state->name, backupidstr, strlen(backupidstr));
    8737             : 
    8738             :     /*
    8739             :      * Mark backup active in shared memory.  We must do full-page WAL writes
    8740             :      * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
    8741             :      * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
    8742             :      * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
    8743             :      * our write to the same page.  This can be fixed as long as the first
    8744             :      * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
    8745             :      * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
    8746             :      * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
    8747             :      * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record.  (Once the
    8748             :      * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
    8749             :      * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
    8750             :      * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
    8751             :      *
    8752             :      * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
    8753             :      * backup from the standby.
    8754             :      *
    8755             :      * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
    8756             :      * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
    8757             :      * XLogInsertRecord().
    8758             :      */
    8759         288 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8760         288 :     XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups++;
    8761         288 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    8762             : 
    8763             :     /*
    8764             :      * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
    8765             :      * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
    8766             :      * after this block is over.
    8767             :      */
    8768         288 :     PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(do_pg_abort_backup, DatumGetBool(true));
    8769             :     {
    8770         288 :         bool        gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
    8771             :         DIR        *tblspcdir;
    8772             :         struct dirent *de;
    8773             :         tablespaceinfo *ti;
    8774             :         int         datadirpathlen;
    8775             : 
    8776             :         /*
    8777             :          * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
    8778             :          * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
    8779             :          * old timeline IDs.  That would otherwise happen if you called
    8780             :          * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
    8781             :          * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
    8782             :          * the beginning with the old timeline ID.  That can cause trouble at
    8783             :          * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
    8784             :          * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
    8785             :          * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
    8786             :          *
    8787             :          * This also ensures that we have emitted a WAL page header that has
    8788             :          * XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE off before we emit the checkpoint record.
    8789             :          * Therefore, if a WAL archiver (such as pglesslog) is trying to
    8790             :          * compress out removable backup blocks, it won't remove any that
    8791             :          * occur after this point.
    8792             :          *
    8793             :          * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
    8794             :          * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
    8795             :          * recovery case described above.
    8796             :          */
    8797         288 :         if (!backup_started_in_recovery)
    8798         274 :             RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    8799             : 
    8800             :         do
    8801             :         {
    8802             :             bool        checkpointfpw;
    8803             : 
    8804             :             /*
    8805             :              * Force a CHECKPOINT.  Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
    8806             :              * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
    8807             :              * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
    8808             :              * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
    8809             :              *
    8810             :              * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
    8811             :              * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
    8812             :              * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
    8813             :              * positions.
    8814             :              *
    8815             :              * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
    8816             :              * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
    8817             :              * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
    8818             :              *
    8819             :              * We use CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE only if requested by user (via
    8820             :              * passing fast = true).  Otherwise this can take awhile.
    8821             :              */
    8822         288 :             RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE | CHECKPOINT_WAIT |
    8823             :                               (fast ? CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE : 0));
    8824             : 
    8825             :             /*
    8826             :              * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
    8827             :              * its REDO pointer.  The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
    8828             :              * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
    8829             :              * pointer.
    8830             :              */
    8831         288 :             LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    8832         288 :             state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
    8833         288 :             state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    8834         288 :             state->starttli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
    8835         288 :             checkpointfpw = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.fullPageWrites;
    8836         288 :             LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    8837             : 
    8838         288 :             if (backup_started_in_recovery)
    8839             :             {
    8840             :                 XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    8841             : 
    8842             :                 /*
    8843             :                  * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
    8844             :                  * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
    8845             :                  * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
    8846             :                  */
    8847          14 :                 SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8848          14 :                 recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
    8849          14 :                 SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    8850             : 
    8851          14 :                 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
    8852           0 :                     ereport(ERROR,
    8853             :                             (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    8854             :                              errmsg("WAL generated with full_page_writes=off was replayed "
    8855             :                                     "since last restartpoint"),
    8856             :                              errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
    8857             :                                      "is corrupt and should not be used. "
    8858             :                                      "Enable full_page_writes and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
    8859             :                                      "and then try an online backup again.")));
    8860             : 
    8861             :                 /*
    8862             :                  * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
    8863             :                  * record and don't write the backup history file, the
    8864             :                  * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
    8865             :                  * that two base backups started at the same time might use
    8866             :                  * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
    8867             :                  */
    8868          14 :                 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
    8869             :             }
    8870             : 
    8871             :             /*
    8872             :              * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
    8873             :              * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
    8874             :              * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
    8875             :              * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
    8876             :              * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
    8877             :              * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
    8878             :              * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
    8879             :              * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
    8880             :              * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
    8881             :              */
    8882         288 :             WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    8883         288 :             if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
    8884             :             {
    8885         288 :                 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
    8886         288 :                 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
    8887             :             }
    8888         288 :             WALInsertLockRelease();
    8889         288 :         } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
    8890             : 
    8891             :         /*
    8892             :          * Construct tablespace_map file.
    8893             :          */
    8894         288 :         datadirpathlen = strlen(DataDir);
    8895             : 
    8896             :         /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
    8897         288 :         tblspcdir = AllocateDir("pg_tblspc");
    8898         926 :         while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, "pg_tblspc")) != NULL)
    8899             :         {
    8900             :             char        fullpath[MAXPGPATH + 10];
    8901             :             char        linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
    8902         638 :             char       *relpath = NULL;
    8903             :             char       *s;
    8904             :             PGFileType  de_type;
    8905             :             char       *badp;
    8906             :             Oid         tsoid;
    8907             : 
    8908             :             /*
    8909             :              * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
    8910             :              *
    8911             :              * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
    8912             :              * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
    8913             :              * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
    8914             :              * criteria, skip it.
    8915             :              */
    8916         638 :             if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
    8917         576 :                 continue;
    8918          62 :             errno = 0;
    8919          62 :             tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
    8920          62 :             if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
    8921           0 :                 continue;
    8922             : 
    8923          62 :             snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "pg_tblspc/%s", de->d_name);
    8924             : 
    8925          62 :             de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
    8926             : 
    8927          62 :             if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
    8928             :             {
    8929             :                 StringInfoData escapedpath;
    8930             :                 int         rllen;
    8931             : 
    8932          34 :                 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
    8933          34 :                 if (rllen < 0)
    8934             :                 {
    8935           0 :                     ereport(WARNING,
    8936             :                             (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
    8937             :                                     fullpath)));
    8938           0 :                     continue;
    8939             :                 }
    8940          34 :                 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
    8941             :                 {
    8942           0 :                     ereport(WARNING,
    8943             :                             (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
    8944             :                                     fullpath)));
    8945           0 :                     continue;
    8946             :                 }
    8947          34 :                 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
    8948             : 
    8949             :                 /*
    8950             :                  * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
    8951             :                  * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
    8952             :                  * elsewhere.
    8953             :                  */
    8954          34 :                 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
    8955           2 :                     strncmp(linkpath, DataDir, datadirpathlen) == 0 &&
    8956           0 :                     IS_DIR_SEP(linkpath[datadirpathlen]))
    8957           0 :                     relpath = pstrdup(linkpath + datadirpathlen + 1);
    8958             : 
    8959             :                 /*
    8960             :                  * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
    8961             :                  * tablespace map file.
    8962             :                  */
    8963          34 :                 initStringInfo(&escapedpath);
    8964         920 :                 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
    8965             :                 {
    8966         886 :                     if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
    8967           0 :                         appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, '\\');
    8968         886 :                     appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, *s);
    8969             :                 }
    8970          34 :                 appendStringInfo(tblspcmapfile, "%s %s\n",
    8971          34 :                                  de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
    8972          34 :                 pfree(escapedpath.data);
    8973             :             }
    8974          28 :             else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
    8975             :             {
    8976             :                 /*
    8977             :                  * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
    8978             :                  * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
    8979             :                  * only.
    8980             :                  *
    8981             :                  * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
    8982             :                  * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
    8983             :                  */
    8984          28 :                 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "pg_tblspc/%s",
    8985          28 :                          de->d_name);
    8986          28 :                 relpath = pstrdup(linkpath);
    8987             :             }
    8988             :             else
    8989             :             {
    8990             :                 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
    8991           0 :                 continue;
    8992             :             }
    8993             : 
    8994          62 :             ti = palloc(sizeof(tablespaceinfo));
    8995          62 :             ti->oid = tsoid;
    8996          62 :             ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
    8997          62 :             ti->rpath = relpath;
    8998          62 :             ti->size = -1;
    8999             : 
    9000          62 :             if (tablespaces)
    9001          62 :                 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
    9002             :         }
    9003         288 :         FreeDir(tblspcdir);
    9004             : 
    9005         288 :         state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    9006             :     }
    9007         288 :     PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(do_pg_abort_backup, DatumGetBool(true));
    9008             : 
    9009         288 :     state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
    9010             : 
    9011             :     /*
    9012             :      * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
    9013             :      */
    9014         288 :     sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING;
    9015         288 : }
    9016             : 
    9017             : /*
    9018             :  * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
    9019             :  */
    9020             : SessionBackupState
    9021         330 : get_backup_status(void)
    9022             : {
    9023         330 :     return sessionBackupState;
    9024             : }
    9025             : 
    9026             : /*
    9027             :  * do_pg_backup_stop
    9028             :  *
    9029             :  * Utility function called at the end of an online backup.  It creates history
    9030             :  * file (if required), resets sessionBackupState and so on.  It can optionally
    9031             :  * wait for WAL segments to be archived.
    9032             :  *
    9033             :  * "state" is filled with the information necessary to restore from this
    9034             :  * backup with its stop LSN (stoppoint), its timeline ID (stoptli), etc.
    9035             :  *
    9036             :  * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
    9037             :  * permissions of the calling user!
    9038             :  */
    9039             : void
    9040         274 : do_pg_backup_stop(BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
    9041             : {
    9042         274 :     bool        backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
    9043             :     char        histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
    9044             :     char        lastxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    9045             :     char        histfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
    9046             :     XLogSegNo   _logSegNo;
    9047             :     FILE       *fp;
    9048             :     int         seconds_before_warning;
    9049         274 :     int         waits = 0;
    9050         274 :     bool        reported_waiting = false;
    9051             : 
    9052             :     Assert(state != NULL);
    9053             : 
    9054         274 :     backup_stopped_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
    9055             : 
    9056             :     /*
    9057             :      * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
    9058             :      * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
    9059             :      */
    9060         274 :     if (!backup_stopped_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
    9061           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    9062             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9063             :                  errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
    9064             :                  errhint("wal_level must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
    9065             : 
    9066             :     /*
    9067             :      * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
    9068             :      *
    9069             :      * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
    9070             :      * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
    9071             :      * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
    9072             :      */
    9073         274 :     WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9074             : 
    9075             :     /*
    9076             :      * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
    9077             :      * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
    9078             :      */
    9079             :     Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups > 0);
    9080         274 :     XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups--;
    9081             : 
    9082             :     /*
    9083             :      * Clean up session-level lock.
    9084             :      *
    9085             :      * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
    9086             :      * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
    9087             :      * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
    9088             :      * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
    9089             :      * cleaned up before it.
    9090             :      */
    9091         274 :     sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
    9092             : 
    9093         274 :     WALInsertLockRelease();
    9094             : 
    9095             :     /*
    9096             :      * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
    9097             :      * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
    9098             :      */
    9099         274 :     if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
    9100           0 :         ereport(ERROR,
    9101             :                 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9102             :                  errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
    9103             :                  errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
    9104             :                          "and should not be used. "
    9105             :                          "Try taking another online backup.")));
    9106             : 
    9107             :     /*
    9108             :      * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
    9109             :      * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
    9110             :      * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
    9111             :      * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
    9112             :      * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
    9113             :      * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
    9114             :      * however.
    9115             :      *
    9116             :      * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
    9117             :      * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
    9118             :      * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
    9119             :      * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
    9120             :      * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
    9121             :      * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
    9122             :      * available.
    9123             :      *
    9124             :      * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
    9125             :      * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
    9126             :      * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
    9127             :      * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
    9128             :      *
    9129             :      * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
    9130             :      * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
    9131             :      * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
    9132             :      * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
    9133             :      * backup history file during recovery.
    9134             :      */
    9135         274 :     if (backup_stopped_in_recovery)
    9136             :     {
    9137             :         XLogRecPtr  recptr;
    9138             : 
    9139             :         /*
    9140             :          * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
    9141             :          * full-page writes.
    9142             :          */
    9143          14 :         SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9144          14 :         recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
    9145          14 :         SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9146             : 
    9147          14 :         if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
    9148           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9149             :                     (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
    9150             :                      errmsg("WAL generated with full_page_writes=off was replayed "
    9151             :                             "during online backup"),
    9152             :                      errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
    9153             :                              "is corrupt and should not be used. "
    9154             :                              "Enable full_page_writes and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
    9155             :                              "and then try an online backup again.")));
    9156             : 
    9157             : 
    9158          14 :         LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9159          14 :         state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
    9160          14 :         state->stoptli = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI;
    9161          14 :         LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9162             :     }
    9163             :     else
    9164             :     {
    9165             :         char       *history_file;
    9166             : 
    9167             :         /*
    9168             :          * Write the backup-end xlog record
    9169             :          */
    9170         260 :         XLogBeginInsert();
    9171         260 :         XLogRegisterData((char *) (&state->startpoint),
    9172             :                          sizeof(state->startpoint));
    9173         260 :         state->stoppoint = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_BACKUP_END);
    9174             : 
    9175             :         /*
    9176             :          * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
    9177             :          * change, so we can read it without a lock.
    9178             :          */
    9179         260 :         state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
    9180             : 
    9181             :         /*
    9182             :          * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
    9183             :          * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
    9184             :          */
    9185         260 :         RequestXLogSwitch(false);
    9186             : 
    9187         260 :         state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
    9188             : 
    9189             :         /*
    9190             :          * Write the backup history file
    9191             :          */
    9192         260 :         XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9193         260 :         BackupHistoryFilePath(histfilepath, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9194             :                               state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
    9195         260 :         fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
    9196         260 :         if (!fp)
    9197           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9198             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    9199             :                      errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
    9200             :                             histfilepath)));
    9201             : 
    9202             :         /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
    9203         260 :         history_file = build_backup_content(state, true);
    9204         260 :         fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
    9205         260 :         pfree(history_file);
    9206             : 
    9207         260 :         if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
    9208           0 :             ereport(ERROR,
    9209             :                     (errcode_for_file_access(),
    9210             :                      errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
    9211             :                             histfilepath)));
    9212             : 
    9213             :         /*
    9214             :          * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files.  As a side effect,
    9215             :          * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
    9216             :          * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
    9217             :          * immediately.
    9218             :          */
    9219         260 :         CleanupBackupHistory();
    9220             :     }
    9221             : 
    9222             :     /*
    9223             :      * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
    9224             :      * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
    9225             :      * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
    9226             :      * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
    9227             :      * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
    9228             :      * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
    9229             :      * the required WAL.
    9230             :      *
    9231             :      * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
    9232             :      * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
    9233             :      * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
    9234             :      * archived as well.
    9235             :      *
    9236             :      * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
    9237             :      * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
    9238             :      * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
    9239             :      * or you can set statement_timeout.  Also, some notices are issued to
    9240             :      * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
    9241             :      */
    9242             : 
    9243         274 :     if (waitforarchive &&
    9244          18 :         ((!backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingActive()) ||
    9245           2 :          (backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingAlways())))
    9246             :     {
    9247           6 :         XLByteToPrevSeg(state->stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9248           6 :         XLogFileName(lastxlogfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9249             :                      wal_segment_size);
    9250             : 
    9251           6 :         XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
    9252           6 :         BackupHistoryFileName(histfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
    9253             :                               state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
    9254             : 
    9255           6 :         seconds_before_warning = 60;
    9256           6 :         waits = 0;
    9257             : 
    9258          18 :         while (XLogArchiveIsBusy(lastxlogfilename) ||
    9259           6 :                XLogArchiveIsBusy(histfilename))
    9260             :         {
    9261           6 :             CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS();
    9262             : 
    9263           6 :             if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
    9264             :             {
    9265           0 :                 ereport(NOTICE,
    9266             :                         (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
    9267           0 :                 reported_waiting = true;
    9268             :             }
    9269             : 
    9270           6 :             (void) WaitLatch(MyLatch,
    9271             :                              WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT | WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH,
    9272             :                              1000L,
    9273             :                              WAIT_EVENT_BACKUP_WAIT_WAL_ARCHIVE);
    9274           6 :             ResetLatch(MyLatch);
    9275             : 
    9276           6 :             if (++waits >= seconds_before_warning)
    9277             :             {
    9278           0 :                 seconds_before_warning *= 2;    /* This wraps in >10 years... */
    9279           0 :                 ereport(WARNING,
    9280             :                         (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
    9281             :                                 waits),
    9282             :                          errhint("Check that your archive_command is executing properly.  "
    9283             :                                  "You can safely cancel this backup, "
    9284             :                                  "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
    9285             :             }
    9286             :         }
    9287             : 
    9288           6 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    9289             :                 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
    9290             :     }
    9291         268 :     else if (waitforarchive)
    9292          12 :         ereport(NOTICE,
    9293             :                 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
    9294         274 : }
    9295             : 
    9296             : 
    9297             : /*
    9298             :  * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
    9299             :  *
    9300             :  * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_backup_stop(), by taking the
    9301             :  * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
    9302             :  * an error handler.
    9303             :  *
    9304             :  * 'arg' indicates that it's being called during backup setup; so
    9305             :  * sessionBackupState has not been modified yet, but runningBackups has
    9306             :  * already been incremented.  When it's false, then it's invoked as a
    9307             :  * before_shmem_exit handler, and therefore we must not change state
    9308             :  * unless sessionBackupState indicates that a backup is actually running.
    9309             :  *
    9310             :  * NB: This gets used as a PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP callback and
    9311             :  * before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking signature.
    9312             :  */
    9313             : void
    9314          20 : do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
    9315             : {
    9316          20 :     bool        during_backup_start = DatumGetBool(arg);
    9317             : 
    9318             :     /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
    9319             :     Assert(!during_backup_start || sessionBackupState == SESSION_BACKUP_NONE);
    9320             : 
    9321          20 :     if (during_backup_start || sessionBackupState != SESSION_BACKUP_NONE)
    9322             :     {
    9323          14 :         WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive();
    9324             :         Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups > 0);
    9325          14 :         XLogCtl->Insert.runningBackups--;
    9326             : 
    9327          14 :         sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE;
    9328          14 :         WALInsertLockRelease();
    9329             : 
    9330          14 :         if (!during_backup_start)
    9331          14 :             ereport(WARNING,
    9332             :                     errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
    9333             :     }
    9334          20 : }
    9335             : 
    9336             : /*
    9337             :  * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
    9338             :  * session, unless this has already been done.
    9339             :  */
    9340             : void
    9341          10 : register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
    9342             : {
    9343             :     static bool already_done = false;
    9344             : 
    9345          10 :     if (already_done)
    9346           2 :         return;
    9347           8 :     before_shmem_exit(do_pg_abort_backup, DatumGetBool(false));
    9348           8 :     already_done = true;
    9349             : }
    9350             : 
    9351             : /*
    9352             :  * Get latest WAL insert pointer
    9353             :  */
    9354             : XLogRecPtr
    9355        4706 : GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
    9356             : {
    9357        4706 :     XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
    9358             :     uint64      current_bytepos;
    9359             : 
    9360        4706 :     SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9361        4706 :     current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
    9362        4706 :     SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
    9363             : 
    9364        4706 :     return XLogBytePosToRecPtr(current_bytepos);
    9365             : }
    9366             : 
    9367             : /*
    9368             :  * Get latest WAL write pointer
    9369             :  */
    9370             : XLogRecPtr
    9371        2574 : GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
    9372             : {
    9373        2574 :     RefreshXLogWriteResult(LogwrtResult);
    9374             : 
    9375        2574 :     return LogwrtResult.Write;
    9376             : }
    9377             : 
    9378             : /*
    9379             :  * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
    9380             :  * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
    9381             :  */
    9382             : void
    9383         118 : GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
    9384             : {
    9385         118 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9386         118 :     *oldrecptr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
    9387         118 :     *oldtli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID;
    9388         118 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9389         118 : }
    9390             : 
    9391             : /* Thin wrapper around ShutdownWalRcv(). */
    9392             : void
    9393        1688 : XLogShutdownWalRcv(void)
    9394             : {
    9395        1688 :     ShutdownWalRcv();
    9396             : 
    9397        1688 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    9398        1688 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = false;
    9399        1688 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9400        1688 : }
    9401             : 
    9402             : /* Enable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
    9403             : void
    9404        1772 : SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9405             : {
    9406        1772 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
    9407        1772 :     XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive = true;
    9408        1772 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9409        1772 : }
    9410             : 
    9411             : bool
    9412           0 : IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
    9413             : {
    9414             :     bool        result;
    9415             : 
    9416           0 :     LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
    9417           0 :     result = XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive;
    9418           0 :     LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
    9419             : 
    9420           0 :     return result;
    9421             : }
    9422             : 
    9423             : /*
    9424             :  * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
    9425             :  */
    9426             : void
    9427         762 : SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
    9428             : {
    9429         762 :     SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9430         762 :     XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = sleeping;
    9431         762 :     SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck);
    9432         762 : }

Generated by: LCOV version 1.14